1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
31 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
36 #include <algorithm>
37 #include <cstdlib>
38 
39 using namespace clang;
40 using namespace sema;
41 
42 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
43   return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
44     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
45   });
46 }
47 
48 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
49 static ExprResult
50 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
51                       const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
52                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
53                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
54   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
55     return ExprError();
56   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
57   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
58   // called on both.
59   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
60   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
61   // being used.
62   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
63     return ExprError();
64   if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
65     S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
66   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
67                                                  VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
68   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
69     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
70 
71   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base);
72   return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()),
73                              CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
74 }
75 
76 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
77                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
78                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
79                                  bool CStyle,
80                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
81 
82 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
83                                                  QualType &ToType,
84                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
85                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
86                                                  bool CStyle);
87 static OverloadingResult
88 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
89                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
90                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
91                         bool AllowExplicit,
92                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
93 
94 
95 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
96 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
97                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
98                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
99 
100 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
101 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
102                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
103                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
104 
105 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
106 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
107                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
108                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
109 
110 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
111 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
112 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
113   static const ImplicitConversionRank
114     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
115     ICR_Exact_Match,
116     ICR_Exact_Match,
117     ICR_Exact_Match,
118     ICR_Exact_Match,
119     ICR_Exact_Match,
120     ICR_Exact_Match,
121     ICR_Promotion,
122     ICR_Promotion,
123     ICR_Promotion,
124     ICR_Conversion,
125     ICR_Conversion,
126     ICR_Conversion,
127     ICR_Conversion,
128     ICR_Conversion,
129     ICR_Conversion,
130     ICR_Conversion,
131     ICR_Conversion,
132     ICR_Conversion,
133     ICR_Conversion,
134     ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening,
135     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
136     ICR_Conversion,
137     ICR_Conversion,
138     ICR_Writeback_Conversion,
139     ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right --
140                      // it was omitted by the patch that added
141                      // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion
142     ICR_C_Conversion,
143     ICR_C_Conversion_Extension
144   };
145   return Rank[(int)Kind];
146 }
147 
148 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
149 /// implicit conversion.
150 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
151   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
152     "No conversion",
153     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
154     "Array-to-pointer",
155     "Function-to-pointer",
156     "Function pointer conversion",
157     "Qualification",
158     "Integral promotion",
159     "Floating point promotion",
160     "Complex promotion",
161     "Integral conversion",
162     "Floating conversion",
163     "Complex conversion",
164     "Floating-integral conversion",
165     "Pointer conversion",
166     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
167     "Boolean conversion",
168     "Compatible-types conversion",
169     "Derived-to-base conversion",
170     "Vector conversion",
171     "Vector splat",
172     "Complex-real conversion",
173     "Block Pointer conversion",
174     "Transparent Union Conversion",
175     "Writeback conversion",
176     "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion",
177     "C specific type conversion",
178     "Incompatible pointer conversion"
179   };
180   return Name[Kind];
181 }
182 
183 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
184 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
185 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
186   First = ICK_Identity;
187   Second = ICK_Identity;
188   Third = ICK_Identity;
189   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
190   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
191   ReferenceBinding = false;
192   DirectBinding = false;
193   IsLvalueReference = true;
194   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
195   BindsToRvalue = false;
196   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
197   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
198   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
199 }
200 
201 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
202 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
203 /// implicit conversions.
204 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
205   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
206   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
207     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
208   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
209     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
210   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
211     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
212   return Rank;
213 }
214 
215 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
216 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
217 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
218 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
219 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
220   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
221   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
222   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
223   // a pointer.
224   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
225       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
226        getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() ||
227        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
228        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
229        getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
230        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
231     return true;
232 
233   return false;
234 }
235 
236 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
237 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
238 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
239 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
240 bool
241 StandardConversionSequence::
242 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
243   QualType FromType = getFromType();
244   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
245 
246   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
247   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
248   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
249   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
250     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
251 
252   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
253     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
254       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
255 
256   return false;
257 }
258 
259 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
260 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
261 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
262   while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
263     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
264     case CK_NoOp:
265     case CK_IntegralCast:
266     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
267     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
268     case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral:
269     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
270     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
271     case CK_FloatingCast:
272       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
273       continue;
274 
275     default:
276       return Converted;
277     }
278   }
279 
280   return Converted;
281 }
282 
283 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
284 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
285 ///
286 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
287 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
288 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
289 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
290 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
291 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
292 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions
293 ///        from floating point types to integral types should be ignored.
294 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(
295     ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue,
296     QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const {
297   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
298 
299   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
300   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
301   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
302   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
303 
304   // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to
305   // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of
306   // the form 'Enum{init}'.
307   if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>())
308     ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
309 
310   switch (Second) {
311   // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it.
312   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
313     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType())
314       goto FloatingIntegralConversion;
315     if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
316       goto IntegralConversion;
317     // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
318     // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
319     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
320 
321   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
322   //
323   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
324   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
325   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
326   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
327   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
328   FloatingIntegralConversion:
329     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
330       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
331     } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
332                ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
333       if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion)
334         return NK_Not_Narrowing;
335       llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
336       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
337       assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression");
338 
339       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
340       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
341         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
342 
343       if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
344         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
345         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
346         Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
347                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
348         // And back.
349         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
350         bool ignored;
351         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
352                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
353         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
354         if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
355           ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
356           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
357           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
358         }
359       } else {
360         // Variables are always narrowings.
361         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
362       }
363     }
364     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
365 
366   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
367   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
368   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
369   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
370   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
371     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
372         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
373       // FromType is larger than ToType.
374       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
375 
376       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
377       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
378         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
379 
380       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
381         // Constant!
382         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
383         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
384         // Convert the source value into the target type.
385         bool ignored;
386         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
387           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
388           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
389         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
390         // values that can be represented.
391         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
392           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
393           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
394         }
395       } else {
396         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
397       }
398     }
399     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
400 
401   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
402   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
403   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
404   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
405   //    value when converted back to the original type.
406   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
407   IntegralConversion: {
408     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
409     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
410     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
411     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
412     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
413     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
414 
415     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
416         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
417         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
418       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
419       llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
420       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
421 
422       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
423       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
424         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
425 
426       if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
427         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
428         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
429       }
430       bool Narrowing = false;
431       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
432         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
433         // narrowing.
434         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
435           Narrowing = true;
436       } else {
437         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
438         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
439         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
440           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
441         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
442         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
443         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
444         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
445         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
446         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
447         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
448         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
449           Narrowing = true;
450       }
451       if (Narrowing) {
452         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
453         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
454         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
455       }
456     }
457     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
458   }
459 
460   default:
461     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
462     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
463   }
464 }
465 
466 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
467 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
468 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
469   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
470   bool PrintedSomething = false;
471   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
472     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
473     PrintedSomething = true;
474   }
475 
476   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
477     if (PrintedSomething) {
478       OS << " -> ";
479     }
480     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
481 
482     if (CopyConstructor) {
483       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
484     } else if (DirectBinding) {
485       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
486     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
487       OS << " (reference binding)";
488     }
489     PrintedSomething = true;
490   }
491 
492   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
493     if (PrintedSomething) {
494       OS << " -> ";
495     }
496     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
497     PrintedSomething = true;
498   }
499 
500   if (!PrintedSomething) {
501     OS << "No conversions required";
502   }
503 }
504 
505 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
506 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
507 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
508   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
509   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
510     Before.dump();
511     OS << " -> ";
512   }
513   if (ConversionFunction)
514     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
515   else
516     OS << "aggregate initialization";
517   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
518     OS << " -> ";
519     After.dump();
520   }
521 }
522 
523 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
524 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
525 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
526   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
527   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
528     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
529   switch (ConversionKind) {
530   case StandardConversion:
531     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
532     Standard.dump();
533     break;
534   case UserDefinedConversion:
535     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
536     UserDefined.dump();
537     break;
538   case EllipsisConversion:
539     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
540     break;
541   case AmbiguousConversion:
542     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
543     break;
544   case BadConversion:
545     OS << "Bad conversion";
546     break;
547   }
548 
549   OS << "\n";
550 }
551 
552 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
553   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
554 }
555 
556 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
557   conversions().~ConversionSet();
558 }
559 
560 void
561 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
562   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
563   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
564   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
565 }
566 
567 namespace {
568   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
569   // template argument information.
570   struct DFIArguments {
571     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
572     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
573   };
574   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
575   // template parameter and template argument information.
576   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
577     TemplateParameter Param;
578   };
579   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument
580   // information and the index of the problematic call argument.
581   struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments {
582     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
583     unsigned CallArgIndex;
584   };
585 }
586 
587 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
588 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
589 DeductionFailureInfo
590 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
591                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
592                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
593   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
594   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
595   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
596   switch (TDK) {
597   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
598   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
599   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
600   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
601   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
602   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
603     Result.Data = nullptr;
604     break;
605 
606   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
607   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
608     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
609     break;
610 
611   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
612   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
613     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
614     auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs;
615     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
616     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
617     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
618     Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex;
619     Result.Data = Saved;
620     break;
621   }
622 
623   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
624     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
625     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
626     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
627     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
628     Result.Data = Saved;
629     break;
630   }
631 
632   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
633   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
634     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
635     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
636     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
637     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
638     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
639     Result.Data = Saved;
640     break;
641   }
642 
643   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
644     Result.Data = Info.take();
645     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
646       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
647           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
648       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
649       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
650     }
651     break;
652 
653   case Sema::TDK_Success:
654   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
655     llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure");
656   }
657 
658   return Result;
659 }
660 
661 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
662   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
663   case Sema::TDK_Success:
664   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
665   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
666   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
667   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
668   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
669   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
670   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
671   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
672     break;
673 
674   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
675   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
676   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
677   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
678   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
679     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
680     Data = nullptr;
681     break;
682 
683   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
684     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
685     Data = nullptr;
686     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
687       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
688       HasDiagnostic = false;
689     }
690     break;
691 
692   // Unhandled
693   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
694     break;
695   }
696 }
697 
698 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
699   if (HasDiagnostic)
700     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
701   return nullptr;
702 }
703 
704 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
705   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
706   case Sema::TDK_Success:
707   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
708   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
709   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
710   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
711   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
712   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
713   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
714   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
715   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
716   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
717     return TemplateParameter();
718 
719   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
720   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
721     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
722 
723   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
724   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
725     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
726 
727   // Unhandled
728   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
729     break;
730   }
731 
732   return TemplateParameter();
733 }
734 
735 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
736   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
737   case Sema::TDK_Success:
738   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
739   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
740   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
741   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
742   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
743   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
744   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
745   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
746   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
747   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
748   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
749     return nullptr;
750 
751   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
752   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
753     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
754 
755   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
756     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
757 
758   // Unhandled
759   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
760     break;
761   }
762 
763   return nullptr;
764 }
765 
766 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
767   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
768   case Sema::TDK_Success:
769   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
770   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
771   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
772   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
773   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
774   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
775   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
776   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
777   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
778     return nullptr;
779 
780   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
781   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
782   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
783   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
784   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
785     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
786 
787   // Unhandled
788   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
789     break;
790   }
791 
792   return nullptr;
793 }
794 
795 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
796   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
797   case Sema::TDK_Success:
798   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
799   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
800   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
801   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
802   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
803   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
804   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
805   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
806   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
807     return nullptr;
808 
809   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
810   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
811   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
812   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
813   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
814     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
815 
816   // Unhandled
817   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
818     break;
819   }
820 
821   return nullptr;
822 }
823 
824 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() {
825   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
826   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
827   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
828     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex;
829 
830   default:
831     return llvm::None;
832   }
833 }
834 
835 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
836   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
837     for (auto &C : i->Conversions)
838       C.~ImplicitConversionSequence();
839     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
840       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
841   }
842 }
843 
844 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) {
845   destroyCandidates();
846   SlabAllocator.Reset();
847   NumInlineBytesUsed = 0;
848   Candidates.clear();
849   Functions.clear();
850   Kind = CSK;
851 }
852 
853 namespace {
854   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
855     struct Entry {
856       Expr **Addr;
857       Expr *Saved;
858     };
859     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
860 
861   public:
862     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
863       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
864       Entry entry = { &E, E };
865       Entries.push_back(entry);
866       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
867     }
868 
869     void restore() {
870       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
871              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
872         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
873     }
874   };
875 }
876 
877 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
878 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
879 ///
880 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
881 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
882 ///
883 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
884 static bool
885 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
886                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
887   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
888     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
889     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
890     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
891 
892     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
893     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
894     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
895         unbridgedCasts) {
896       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
897       return false;
898     }
899 
900     // Go ahead and check everything else.
901     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
902     if (result.isInvalid())
903       return true;
904 
905     E = result.get();
906     return false;
907   }
908 
909   // Nothing to do.
910   return false;
911 }
912 
913 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
914 /// placeholders.
915 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
916                                             MultiExprArg Args,
917                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
918   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
919     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
920       return true;
921 
922   return false;
923 }
924 
925 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the
926 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if
927 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as
928 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't
929 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or
930 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be
931 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying
932 /// declaration.
933 ///
934 /// Example: Given the following input:
935 ///
936 ///   void f(int, float); // #1
937 ///   void f(int, int); // #2
938 ///   int f(int, int); // #3
939 ///
940 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload
941 /// will not be used.
942 ///
943 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing
944 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have
945 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is
946 /// unchanged.
947 ///
948 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare
949 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then
950 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of
951 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and
952 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
953 ///
954 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class
955 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations
956 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's
957 /// signature.
958 Sema::OverloadKind
959 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
960                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
961   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
962          I != E; ++I) {
963     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
964 
965     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
966     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
967       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
968 
969       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
970       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
971       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
972 
973       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
974     }
975 
976     // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration
977     // if one of them is hidden.
978     if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I))
979       continue;
980 
981     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
982     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
983     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
984     // function templates hide function templates with different
985     // return types or template parameter lists.
986     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
987       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
988       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
989 
990     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
991       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
992         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
993           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
994           continue;
995         }
996 
997         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
998             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
999           continue;
1000 
1001         Match = *I;
1002         return Ovl_Match;
1003       }
1004 
1005       // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should
1006       // not be overloadable or redeclarable.
1007       if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) {
1008         Match = *I;
1009         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1010       }
1011     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) {
1012       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
1013       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
1014       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
1015     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
1016       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
1017     } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
1018       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
1019       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
1020       // template instantiation.
1021       //
1022       // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class
1023       // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator.
1024       if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) {
1025         Match = *I;
1026         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1027       }
1028     } else {
1029       // (C++ 13p1):
1030       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
1031       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
1032       Match = *I;
1033       return Ovl_NonFunction;
1034     }
1035   }
1036 
1037   return Ovl_Overload;
1038 }
1039 
1040 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1041                       bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs) {
1042   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
1043   if (New->isMain())
1044     return false;
1045 
1046   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
1047   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
1048     return false;
1049 
1050   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1051   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1052 
1053   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
1054   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
1055   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
1056   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
1057     return true;
1058 
1059   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
1060   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
1061   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
1062 
1063   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1064   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1065   // in the signature, they are overloads.
1066 
1067   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1068   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1069   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1070       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1071     return false;
1072 
1073   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1074   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
1075 
1076   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1077   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1078   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1079   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1080       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
1081        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
1082        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
1083     return true;
1084 
1085   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1086   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1087   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1088   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1089   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1090   //   signature.
1091   //
1092   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1093   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1094   //
1095   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1096   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1097   if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1098       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1099                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1100                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1101        OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType()))
1102     return true;
1103 
1104   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1105   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1106   //
1107   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1108   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1109   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1110   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1111   // can be overloaded.
1112   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1113   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1114   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1115       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1116     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1117       if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules &&
1118           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1119            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1120         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1121         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1122         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1123         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1124         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1125         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1126         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1127           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1128         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1129       }
1130       return true;
1131     }
1132 
1133     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1134     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1135     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1136     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1137     unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
1138     unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
1139     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1140         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1141       NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1142 
1143     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1144     OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1145     NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1146     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1147       return true;
1148   }
1149 
1150   // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we
1151   // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function
1152   // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with
1153   // pass_object_size or it doesn't.
1154   if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) !=
1155       functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old))
1156     return true;
1157 
1158   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1159   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1160          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1161          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1162          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1163          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1164        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1165     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1166       return true;
1167     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1168     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1169     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1170     if (NewID != OldID)
1171       return true;
1172   }
1173 
1174   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) {
1175     // Don't allow overloading of destructors.  (In theory we could, but it
1176     // would be a giant change to clang.)
1177     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New))
1178       return false;
1179 
1180     CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New),
1181                        OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old);
1182     if (NewTarget == CFT_InvalidTarget)
1183       return false;
1184 
1185     assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && "Unexpected invalid target.");
1186 
1187     // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA
1188     // target attributes.
1189     return NewTarget != OldTarget;
1190   }
1191 
1192   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1193   return false;
1194 }
1195 
1196 /// Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1197 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1198 ///
1199 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1200 /// an available function, false otherwise.
1201 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1202   if (!FD->isUnavailable())
1203     return false;
1204 
1205   // Walk up the context of the caller.
1206   Decl *C = cast<Decl>(CurContext);
1207   do {
1208     if (C->isUnavailable())
1209       return false;
1210   } while ((C = cast_or_null<Decl>(C->getDeclContext())));
1211   return true;
1212 }
1213 
1214 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1215 ///
1216 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1217 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1218 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1219 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1220                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1221                          bool AllowExplicit,
1222                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1223                          bool CStyle,
1224                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1225                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1226   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1227 
1228   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1229     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1230     // we can perform.
1231     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1232     return ICS;
1233   }
1234 
1235   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1236   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1237                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1238   switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
1239                                   Conversions, AllowExplicit,
1240                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) {
1241   case OR_Success:
1242   case OR_Deleted:
1243     ICS.setUserDefined();
1244     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1245     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1246     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1247     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1248     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1249     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1250     //   called for those cases.
1251     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1252           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1253       QualType FromCanon
1254         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1255       QualType ToCanon
1256         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1257       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1258           (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
1259            S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1260         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1261         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1262         DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction;
1263         ICS.setStandard();
1264         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1265         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1266         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1267         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1268         ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found;
1269         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1270           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1271       }
1272     }
1273     break;
1274 
1275   case OR_Ambiguous:
1276     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1277     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1278     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1279     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1280          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1281       if (Cand->Viable)
1282         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
1283     break;
1284 
1285     // Fall through.
1286   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
1287     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1288     break;
1289   }
1290 
1291   return ICS;
1292 }
1293 
1294 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1295 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1296 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1297 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1298 ///
1299 ///   void f(float f);
1300 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1301 ///
1302 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1303 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1304 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1305 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1306 //
1307 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1308 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1309 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1310 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1311 /// "BadConversion".
1312 ///
1313 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1314 /// not permitted.
1315 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1316 /// permitted.
1317 ///
1318 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1319 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1320 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1322 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1323                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1324                       bool AllowExplicit,
1325                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1326                       bool CStyle,
1327                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1328                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1329   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1330   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1331                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1332     ICS.setStandard();
1333     return ICS;
1334   }
1335 
1336   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1337     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1338     return ICS;
1339   }
1340 
1341   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1342   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1343   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1344   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1345   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1346   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1347   //   called for those cases.
1348   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1349   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1350       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1351        S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromType, ToType))) {
1352     ICS.setStandard();
1353     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1354     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1355     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1356 
1357     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1358     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1359     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1360     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1361     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1362 
1363     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1364     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1365       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1366 
1367     return ICS;
1368   }
1369 
1370   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1371                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1372                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1373                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1374 }
1375 
1376 ImplicitConversionSequence
1377 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1378                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1379                             bool AllowExplicit,
1380                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1381                             bool CStyle,
1382                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1383   return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1384                                  SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1385                                  InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1386                                  AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1387                                  /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1388 }
1389 
1390 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1391 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1392 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1393 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1394 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1395 ExprResult
1396 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1397                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
1398   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1399   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
1400 }
1401 
1402 ExprResult
1403 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1404                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
1405                                 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
1406   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1407     return ExprError();
1408 
1409   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1410   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1411     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1412       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1413   if (getLangOpts().ObjC1)
1414     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(),
1415                                       ToType, From->getType(), From);
1416   ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1417                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1418                                 AllowExplicit,
1419                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1420                                 /*CStyle=*/false,
1421                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1422                                 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1423   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1424 }
1425 
1426 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1427 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function
1428 /// type.
1429 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1430                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1431   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1432     return false;
1433 
1434   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1435   //                    or F(t noexcept) -> F(t)
1436   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1437   //   - a pointer
1438   //   - a member pointer
1439   //   - a block pointer
1440   // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType.
1441   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1442   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1443   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1444   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1445   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1446     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1447       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1448       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1449     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1450       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1451       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1452     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1453       auto ToMPT = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>();
1454       auto FromMPT = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>();
1455       // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function.
1456       if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass())
1457         return false;
1458       CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType();
1459       CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType();
1460     } else {
1461       return false;
1462     }
1463 
1464     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1465     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1466     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1467       return false;
1468   }
1469 
1470   const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1471   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1472 
1473   const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo);
1474   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo();
1475 
1476   bool Changed = false;
1477 
1478   // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type.
1479   if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) {
1480     FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1481     Changed = true;
1482   }
1483 
1484   // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type.
1485   if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) {
1486     const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn);
1487     if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) {
1488       FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(
1489           Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0),
1490                                                    EST_None)
1491                  .getTypePtr());
1492       Changed = true;
1493     }
1494 
1495     // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid
1496     // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be
1497     // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list.
1498     SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
1499     bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
1500     if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT,
1501                                       CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) &&
1502         CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) {
1503       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo();
1504       ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos =
1505           NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data();
1506       QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(),
1507                                             FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo);
1508       FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>();
1509       Changed = true;
1510     }
1511   }
1512 
1513   if (!Changed)
1514     return false;
1515 
1516   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1517   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1518 
1519   ResultTy = ToType;
1520   return true;
1521 }
1522 
1523 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1524 /// vector conversion.
1525 ///
1526 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1527 /// conversion.
1528 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1529                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1530   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1531   // conversion.
1532   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1533     return false;
1534 
1535   // Identical types require no conversions.
1536   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1537     return false;
1538 
1539   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1540   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1541     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1542     // identity conversion.
1543     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1544       return false;
1545 
1546     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1547     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1548       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1549       return true;
1550     }
1551   }
1552 
1553   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1554   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1555   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1556   //   same size
1557   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1558     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1559         S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
1560       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1561       return true;
1562     }
1563   }
1564 
1565   return false;
1566 }
1567 
1568 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1569                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1570                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1571                                 bool CStyle);
1572 
1573 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1574 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1575 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1576 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1577 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1578 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1579 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1580 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1581 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1582                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1583                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1584                                  bool CStyle,
1585                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1586   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1587 
1588   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1589   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1590   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1591   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1592   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1593 
1594   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1595   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them.
1596   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1597       (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()))
1598     return false;
1599 
1600   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1601   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1602   // (C++ 4p1).
1603 
1604   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1605     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1606     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1607           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1608                                                  AccessPair)) {
1609       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1610       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1611       FromType = Fn->getType();
1612       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1613 
1614       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1615       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1616       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1617                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1618         QualType resultTy;
1619         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1620         if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType,
1621               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1622           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1623           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1624             return false;
1625       }
1626 
1627       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1628       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1629       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1630       // expression.
1631       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1632       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1633         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1634                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1635         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1636                == UO_AddrOf &&
1637                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1638         const Type *ClassType
1639           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1640         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1641       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1642         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1643                UO_AddrOf &&
1644                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1645         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1646       }
1647 
1648       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1649       // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't
1650       // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block.
1651       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1652         FromType,
1653         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1654     } else {
1655       return false;
1656     }
1657   }
1658   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1659   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1660   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1661   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1662   if (argIsLValue &&
1663       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1664       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1665     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1666 
1667     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1668     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1669     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1670     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1671       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1672 
1673     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1674     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1675     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1676     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1677     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1678   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1679     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1680     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1681 
1682     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1683     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1684     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1685     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1686 
1687     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1688       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1689       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1690 
1691       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1692       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1693       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1694       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1695       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1696       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1697       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1698       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1699       return true;
1700     }
1701   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1702     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1703     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1704 
1705     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts()))
1706       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
1707         if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
1708           return false;
1709 
1710     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1711     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1712     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1713     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1714   } else {
1715     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1716     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1717   }
1718   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1719 
1720   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1721   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1722   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1723   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1724   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1725   // conversion.
1726   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1727   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1728   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1729     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1730     // conversion to do.
1731     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1732   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1733     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1734     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1735     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1736   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1737     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1738     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1739     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1740   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1741     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1742     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1743     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1744   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1745              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1746               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1747               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1748               FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1749               FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1750     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1751     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1752     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1753   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1754              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1755     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1756     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1757     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1758   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1759     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1760     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1761     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1762   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1763              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1764     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1765     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1766     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1767   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1768     // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if
1769     // their representation is different until there is back end support
1770     // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double.
1771     if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) !=
1772         &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) {
1773       bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty &&
1774                                     ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ||
1775                                    (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy &&
1776                                     ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty));
1777       if (Float128AndLongDouble &&
1778           (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ==
1779            &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()))
1780         return false;
1781     }
1782     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1783     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1784     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1785   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1786               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1787              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1788               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1789     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1790     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1791     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1792   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1793     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1794   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1795              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1796     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1797   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1798                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1799     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1800     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1801     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1802     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1803   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1804                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1805     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1806     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1807   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1808     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1809     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1810   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1811              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1812     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1813     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1814     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1815   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1816                                              InOverloadResolution,
1817                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1818     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1819     FromType = ToType;
1820   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1821                                  CStyle)) {
1822     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1823     // appropriately.
1824     return true;
1825   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1826              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1827              From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) {
1828     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1829     FromType = ToType;
1830   } else if (ToType->isQueueT() &&
1831              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1832              (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1833     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion;
1834     FromType = ToType;
1835   } else {
1836     // No second conversion required.
1837     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1838   }
1839   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1840 
1841   // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a
1842   // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]).
1843   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1844   if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1845     // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of
1846     // 'noreturn' (Clang extension).
1847     SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion;
1848   } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1849                                          ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1850     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1851     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1852     FromType = ToType;
1853   } else {
1854     // No conversion required
1855     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1856   }
1857 
1858   // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1859   //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1860   //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1861   //   a conversion. [...]
1862   QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1863   QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1864   if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1865                                      == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1866       CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1867     FromType = ToType;
1868     CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1869   }
1870 
1871   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1872 
1873   if (CanonFrom == CanonTo)
1874     return true;
1875 
1876   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1877   // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C.
1878   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution)
1879     return false;
1880 
1881   ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From};
1882   Sema::AssignConvertType Conv =
1883       S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER,
1884                                          /*Diagnose=*/false,
1885                                          /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false,
1886                                          /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
1887   ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv;
1888   switch (Conv) {
1889   case Sema::Compatible:
1890     SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
1891     break;
1892   // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an
1893   // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop
1894   // qualifiers, as well.
1895   case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
1896   case Sema::IncompatiblePointer:
1897   case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign:
1898     SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
1899     break;
1900   default:
1901     return false;
1902   }
1903 
1904   // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the
1905   // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the
1906   // function.
1907   SCS.Second = SecondConv;
1908   SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
1909 
1910   // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other
1911   // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just
1912   // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything
1913   // from making this ICK_Qualification.
1914   SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1915   SCS.setToType(2, ToType);
1916   return true;
1917 }
1918 
1919 static bool
1920 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1921                                      QualType &ToType,
1922                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
1923                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1924                                      bool CStyle) {
1925 
1926   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1927   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1928     return false;
1929   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1930   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1931   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1932   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
1933     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1934                              CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
1935       ToType = it->getType();
1936       return true;
1937     }
1938   }
1939   return false;
1940 }
1941 
1942 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1943 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1944 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1945 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1946 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1947   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1948   // All integers are built-in.
1949   if (!To) {
1950     return false;
1951   }
1952 
1953   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1954   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1955   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1956   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1957   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
1958   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1959       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
1960     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1961         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1962          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1963          // less than int to an int.
1964          Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) {
1965       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1966     }
1967 
1968     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1969   }
1970 
1971   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
1972   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1973   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1974   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1975   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1976   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
1977   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
1978   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
1979   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
1980   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1981   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
1982   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
1983   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1984   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1985   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1986   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1987   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1988   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
1989   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1990     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1991     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1992     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1993       return false;
1994 
1995     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1996     // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting
1997     // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider
1998     // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression.
1999     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
2000       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2001       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
2002              IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType);
2003     }
2004 
2005     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
2006     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
2007         isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType))
2008       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2009           ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
2010   }
2011 
2012   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
2013   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
2014   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
2015   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
2016   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
2017   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
2018   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
2019   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
2020   //   type.
2021   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
2022       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
2023     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
2024     // unsigned.
2025     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
2026     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
2027 
2028     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
2029     // order. Try each of these types.
2030     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
2031       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
2032       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
2033       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
2034     };
2035     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
2036       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2037       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
2038           (FromSize == ToSize &&
2039            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
2040         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
2041         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
2042         // promotion.
2043         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2044       }
2045     }
2046   }
2047 
2048   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
2049   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
2050   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
2051   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
2052   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
2053   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
2054   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
2055   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
2056   // conversion.
2057   if (From) {
2058     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
2059       llvm::APSInt BitWidth;
2060       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
2061           MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
2062         llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
2063         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
2064 
2065         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
2066         if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
2067             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
2068           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2069         }
2070 
2071         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
2072         // that fits into an unsigned int?
2073         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
2074           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2075         }
2076 
2077         return false;
2078       }
2079     }
2080   }
2081 
2082   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
2083   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
2084   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
2085     return true;
2086   }
2087 
2088   return false;
2089 }
2090 
2091 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
2092 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
2093 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2094 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2095   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
2096     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2097       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
2098       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
2099       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
2100           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
2101         return true;
2102 
2103       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
2104       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
2105       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
2106       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2107           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
2108            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
2109           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble ||
2110            ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))
2111         return true;
2112 
2113       // Half can be promoted to float.
2114       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
2115            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
2116           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
2117         return true;
2118     }
2119 
2120   return false;
2121 }
2122 
2123 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
2124 ///
2125 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
2126 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
2127 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
2128 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2129   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2130   if (!FromComplex)
2131     return false;
2132 
2133   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2134   if (!ToComplex)
2135     return false;
2136 
2137   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
2138                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
2139     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
2140                         ToComplex->getElementType());
2141 }
2142 
2143 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
2144 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
2145 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
2146 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
2147 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
2148 ///
2149 static QualType
2150 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
2151                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
2152                                    ASTContext &Context,
2153                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
2154   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
2155           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
2156          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
2157 
2158   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
2159   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
2160     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2161 
2162   QualType CanonFromPointee
2163     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
2164   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
2165   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
2166 
2167   if (StripObjCLifetime)
2168     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
2169 
2170   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
2171   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
2172     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
2173     if (!ToType.isNull())
2174       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2175 
2176     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
2177     // already.
2178     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2179       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
2180     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
2181   }
2182 
2183   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
2184   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
2185     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
2186 
2187   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2188     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2189   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2190 }
2191 
2192 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
2193                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2194                                                ASTContext &Context) {
2195   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
2196   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
2197   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
2198       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
2199     return !InOverloadResolution;
2200 
2201   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2202                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2203                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
2204 }
2205 
2206 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2207 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
2208 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
2209 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
2210 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
2211 /// ConvertedType.
2212 ///
2213 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2214 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2215 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2216 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2217 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2218 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
2219 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2220 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2221 /// should result in a warning.
2222 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2223                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2224                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2225                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2226   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2227   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2228                               IncompatibleObjC))
2229     return true;
2230 
2231   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2232   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2233       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2234     ConvertedType = ToType;
2235     return true;
2236   }
2237 
2238   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2239   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2240       ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2241     ConvertedType = ToType;
2242     return true;
2243   }
2244   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2245   // pointer type.
2246   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2247       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2248     ConvertedType = ToType;
2249     return true;
2250   }
2251 
2252   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2253   // pointer constant.
2254   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2255       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2256     ConvertedType = ToType;
2257     return true;
2258   }
2259 
2260   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2261   if (!ToTypePtr)
2262     return false;
2263 
2264   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2265   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2266     ConvertedType = ToType;
2267     return true;
2268   }
2269 
2270   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2271   // , including objective-c pointers.
2272   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2273   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2274       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2275     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2276                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2277                                                        ToPointeeType,
2278                                                        ToType, Context);
2279     return true;
2280   }
2281   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2282   if (!FromTypePtr)
2283     return false;
2284 
2285   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2286 
2287   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2288   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2289   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2290     return false;
2291 
2292   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2293   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2294   // 4.10p2).
2295   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2296       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2297     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2298                                                        ToPointeeType,
2299                                                        ToType, Context,
2300                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2301     return true;
2302   }
2303 
2304   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2305   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2306       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2307     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2308                                                        ToPointeeType,
2309                                                        ToType, Context);
2310     return true;
2311   }
2312 
2313   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2314   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2315   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2316       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2317     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2318                                                        ToPointeeType,
2319                                                        ToType, Context);
2320     return true;
2321   }
2322 
2323   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2324   //
2325   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2326   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2327   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2328   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2329   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2330   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2331   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2332   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2333   //
2334   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2335   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2336   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2337       FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2338       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2339       IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2340     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2341                                                        ToPointeeType,
2342                                                        ToType, Context);
2343     return true;
2344   }
2345 
2346   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2347       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2348     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2349                                                        ToPointeeType,
2350                                                        ToType, Context);
2351     return true;
2352   }
2353 
2354   return false;
2355 }
2356 
2357 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2358 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2359   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2360 
2361   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2362   if (TQs == Qs)
2363     return T;
2364 
2365   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2366     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2367 
2368   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2369 }
2370 
2371 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2372 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2373 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2374 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2375                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2376                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2377   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
2378     return false;
2379 
2380   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2381   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2382 
2383   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2384   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2385     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2386   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2387     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2388 
2389   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2390     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2391     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2392     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2393                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2394       return false;
2395 
2396     // Conversion between Objective-C pointers.
2397     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2398       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2399       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2400       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2401           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2402                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2403         return false;
2404       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2405                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2406                                                          ToType, Context);
2407       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2408       return true;
2409     }
2410 
2411     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2412       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2413       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2414       // complain about it.
2415       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2416       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2417                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2418                                                          ToType, Context);
2419       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2420       return true;
2421     }
2422   }
2423   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2424   QualType ToPointeeType;
2425   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2426     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2427   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2428             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2429     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2430     // to a block pointer type.
2431     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2432       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2433       return true;
2434     }
2435     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2436   }
2437   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2438            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2439     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2440     // pointer to any object.
2441     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2442     return true;
2443   }
2444   else
2445     return false;
2446 
2447   QualType FromPointeeType;
2448   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2449     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2450   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2451            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2452     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2453   else
2454     return false;
2455 
2456   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2457   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2458   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2459       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2460                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2461     // We always complain about this conversion.
2462     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2463     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2464     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2465     return true;
2466   }
2467   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2468   // as in I* to id.
2469   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2470       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2471       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2472                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2473 
2474     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2475     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2476     return true;
2477   }
2478 
2479   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2480   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2481   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2482   // complain about it).
2483   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2484     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2485   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2486     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2487   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2488     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2489     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2490     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2491           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2492       return false;
2493 
2494     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2495     // function types are obviously different.
2496     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2497         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2498         FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2499       return false;
2500 
2501     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2502     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2503         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2504       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2505     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2506                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2507                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2508       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2509       HasObjCConversion = true;
2510     } else {
2511       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2512       return false;
2513     }
2514 
2515     // Check argument types.
2516     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2517          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2518       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2519       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2520       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2521             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2522         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2523       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2524                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2525         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2526         HasObjCConversion = true;
2527       } else {
2528         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2529         return false;
2530       }
2531     }
2532 
2533     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2534       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2535       // conversion, but complain about it.
2536       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2537       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2538       return true;
2539     }
2540   }
2541 
2542   return false;
2543 }
2544 
2545 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2546 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2547 ///
2548 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2549 ///
2550 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2551 ///
2552 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2553 /// this conversion.
2554 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2555                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2556   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2557       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2558     return false;
2559 
2560   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2561   QualType ToPointee;
2562   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2563     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2564   else
2565     return false;
2566 
2567   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2568   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2569       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2570       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2571     return false;
2572 
2573   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2574   QualType FromPointee;
2575   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2576     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2577   else
2578     return false;
2579 
2580   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2581   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2582       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2583        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2584     return false;
2585 
2586   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2587   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2588   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2589     return false;
2590 
2591   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2592   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2593   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2594   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2595 
2596   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2597   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2598   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2599   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2600     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2601   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2602                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2603     return false;
2604 
2605   /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2606   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2607   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2608   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2609   return true;
2610 }
2611 
2612 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2613                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2614   QualType ToPointeeType;
2615   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2616         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2617     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2618   else
2619     return false;
2620 
2621   QualType FromPointeeType;
2622   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2623       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2624     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2625   else
2626     return false;
2627   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2628   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2629   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2630 
2631   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2632     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2633   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2634     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2635 
2636   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2637     return false;
2638 
2639   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2640     return true;
2641 
2642   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2643   // function types are obviously different.
2644   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2645       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2646     return false;
2647 
2648   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2649   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2650   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2651     return false;
2652 
2653   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2654   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2655                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2656     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2657   } else {
2658     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2659     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2660     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2661         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2662        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2663 
2664      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2665        // OK exact match.
2666      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2667                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2668      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2669        return false;
2670      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2671      }
2672      else
2673        return false;
2674    }
2675 
2676    // Check argument types.
2677    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2678         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2679      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2680      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2681      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2682      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2683        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2684      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2685                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2686        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2687          return false;
2688        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2689      } else
2690        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2691        return false;
2692    }
2693 
2694    SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
2695    bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
2696    if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType,
2697                                       CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT,
2698                                       NewParamInfos))
2699      return false;
2700 
2701    ConvertedType = ToType;
2702    return true;
2703 }
2704 
2705 enum {
2706   ft_default,
2707   ft_different_class,
2708   ft_parameter_arity,
2709   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2710   ft_return_type,
2711   ft_qualifer_mismatch,
2712   ft_noexcept
2713 };
2714 
2715 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles
2716 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly.
2717 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) {
2718   if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
2719     return FPT;
2720 
2721   if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
2722     return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2723 
2724   return nullptr;
2725 }
2726 
2727 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2728 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2729 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2730 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2731                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2732   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2733   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2734     PDiag << ft_default;
2735     return;
2736   }
2737 
2738   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2739   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2740     const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2741                             *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2742     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2743       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2744             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2745       return;
2746     }
2747     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2748     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2749   }
2750 
2751   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2752     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2753   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2754     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2755 
2756   // Remove references.
2757   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2758   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2759 
2760   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2761   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2762       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2763     PDiag << ft_default;
2764     return;
2765   }
2766 
2767   // No extra info for same types.
2768   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2769     PDiag << ft_default;
2770     return;
2771   }
2772 
2773   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType),
2774                           *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType);
2775 
2776   // Both types need to be function types.
2777   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2778     PDiag << ft_default;
2779     return;
2780   }
2781 
2782   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2783     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2784           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2785     return;
2786   }
2787 
2788   // Handle different parameter types.
2789   unsigned ArgPos;
2790   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2791     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2792           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2793           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2794     return;
2795   }
2796 
2797   // Handle different return type.
2798   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2799                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2800     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2801           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2802     return;
2803   }
2804 
2805   unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2806            ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2807   if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2808     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2809     return;
2810   }
2811 
2812   // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17
2813   // onwards).
2814   if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2815           ->isNothrow() !=
2816       cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2817           ->isNothrow()) {
2818     PDiag << ft_noexcept;
2819     return;
2820   }
2821 
2822   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2823   PDiag << ft_default;
2824 }
2825 
2826 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2827 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2828 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2829 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2830 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2831                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2832                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2833   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2834                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2835                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2836        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2837     if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(),
2838                              N->getUnqualifiedType())) {
2839       if (ArgPos)
2840         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2841       return false;
2842     }
2843   }
2844   return true;
2845 }
2846 
2847 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2848 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2849 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2850 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2851 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2852 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2853 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2854                                   CastKind &Kind,
2855                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2856                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess,
2857                                   bool Diagnose) {
2858   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2859   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2860 
2861   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2862 
2863   if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2864       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2865           Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2866     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2867       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2868                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2869                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2870     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2871       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2872         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2873   }
2874   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2875     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2876       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2877                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
2878 
2879       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2880           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2881         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2882         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
2883         unsigned InaccessibleID = 0;
2884         unsigned AmbigiousID = 0;
2885         if (Diagnose) {
2886           InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base;
2887           AmbigiousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv;
2888         }
2889         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(
2890                 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbigiousID,
2891                 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(),
2892                 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess))
2893           return true;
2894 
2895         // The conversion was successful.
2896         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
2897       }
2898 
2899       if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2900           FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2901         assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
2902                "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!");
2903         Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj)
2904             << From->getSourceRange();
2905       }
2906     }
2907   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2908                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2909     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2910           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2911       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2912       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2913       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
2914       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
2915         return false;
2916     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2917       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2918     } else {
2919       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2920     }
2921   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2922     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2923       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
2924   }
2925 
2926   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2927   // reasons.
2928   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2929     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2930 
2931   return false;
2932 }
2933 
2934 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2935 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2936 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2937 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2938 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2939 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
2940                                      QualType ToType,
2941                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2942                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2943   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2944   if (!ToTypePtr)
2945     return false;
2946 
2947   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
2948   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2949                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2950                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
2951     ConvertedType = ToType;
2952     return true;
2953   }
2954 
2955   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
2956   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2957   if (!FromTypePtr)
2958     return false;
2959 
2960   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2961   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2962   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2963   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2964 
2965   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2966       IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, FromClass)) {
2967     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2968                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
2969     return true;
2970   }
2971 
2972   return false;
2973 }
2974 
2975 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2976 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
2977 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
2978 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2979 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2980 /// otherwise.
2981 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2982                                         CastKind &Kind,
2983                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
2984                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2985   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2986   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2987   if (!FromPtrType) {
2988     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
2989     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2990                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
2991            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
2992     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
2993     return false;
2994   }
2995 
2996   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2997   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2998                       "that is not a member pointer.");
2999 
3000   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3001   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3002 
3003   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
3004   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3005   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3006 
3007   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
3008                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
3009   bool DerivationOkay =
3010       IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
3011   assert(DerivationOkay &&
3012          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
3013   (void)DerivationOkay;
3014 
3015   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
3016                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
3017     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
3018     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
3019       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
3020     return true;
3021   }
3022 
3023   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
3024     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
3025       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
3026       << From->getSourceRange();
3027     return true;
3028   }
3029 
3030   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
3031     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
3032                          Paths.front(),
3033                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
3034 
3035   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
3036   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
3037   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
3038   return false;
3039 }
3040 
3041 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
3042 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
3043 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
3044                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
3045   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
3046   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
3047       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
3048     return false;
3049 
3050   return true;
3051 }
3052 
3053 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
3054 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
3055 /// (C++ 4.4).
3056 ///
3057 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
3058 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
3059 /// object lifetime.
3060 bool
3061 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3062                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3063   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
3064   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
3065   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3066 
3067   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
3068   // qualification conversion.
3069   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
3070     return false;
3071 
3072   // (C++ 4.4p4):
3073   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
3074   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
3075   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
3076   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
3077   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
3078     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3079     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3080     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
3081     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
3082     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
3083     // unwrap.
3084     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
3085 
3086     Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
3087     Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
3088 
3089     // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void.
3090     if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType())
3091       FromQuals.removeUnaligned();
3092 
3093     // Objective-C ARC:
3094     //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
3095     if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3096         UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
3097       if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
3098         if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
3099           ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3100         FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3101         ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3102       } else {
3103         // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
3104         // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
3105         return false;
3106       }
3107     }
3108 
3109     // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
3110     if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
3111         (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
3112       FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3113       ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3114     }
3115 
3116     //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
3117     //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
3118     if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
3119       return false;
3120 
3121     //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
3122     //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
3123     if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
3124         && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
3125       return false;
3126 
3127     // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
3128     // include const.
3129     PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
3130       = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
3131   }
3132 
3133   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
3134   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
3135   // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
3136   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
3137   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
3138   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
3139 }
3140 
3141 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
3142 /// atomic type.
3143 ///
3144 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
3145 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
3146 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3147                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
3148                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
3149                                 bool CStyle) {
3150   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
3151   if (!ToAtomic)
3152     return false;
3153 
3154   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
3155   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
3156                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
3157                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
3158     return false;
3159 
3160   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
3161   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
3162   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
3163   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3164     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
3165   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
3166   return true;
3167 }
3168 
3169 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
3170                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
3171                                               QualType Type) {
3172   const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
3173       Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3174   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
3175     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
3176     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
3177       return true;
3178   }
3179   return false;
3180 }
3181 
3182 static OverloadingResult
3183 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3184                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
3185                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3186                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3187                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
3188   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3189   for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) {
3190     auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3191     if (!Info)
3192       continue;
3193 
3194     bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
3195                   S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor) &&
3196                   (AllowExplicit || !Info.Constructor->isExplicit());
3197     if (Usable) {
3198       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3199       // suppress conversions.
3200       bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3201           S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3202       if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3203         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3204                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From,
3205                                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3206       else
3207         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From,
3208                                CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3209     }
3210   }
3211 
3212   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3213 
3214   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3215   switch (auto Result =
3216             CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(),
3217                                             Best)) {
3218   case OR_Deleted:
3219   case OR_Success: {
3220     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3221     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
3222     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
3223     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3224     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3225     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3226     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3227     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3228     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3229     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3230     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3231     return Result;
3232   }
3233 
3234   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3235     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3236   case OR_Ambiguous:
3237     return OR_Ambiguous;
3238   }
3239 
3240   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3241 }
3242 
3243 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3244 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3245 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3246 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3247 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3248 /// false and User is unspecified.
3249 ///
3250 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3251 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3252 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3253 ///
3254 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3255 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3256 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3257 static OverloadingResult
3258 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3259                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3260                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3261                         bool AllowExplicit,
3262                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3263   assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3264   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3265 
3266   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3267   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3268 
3269   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3270   // constructors.
3271   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3272     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3273     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3274     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3275     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3276     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3277     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3278     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3279     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3280     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3281         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3282          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), ToType)))
3283       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3284 
3285     if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) {
3286       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3287     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3288                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3289 
3290       Expr **Args = &From;
3291       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3292       bool ListInitializing = false;
3293       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3294         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3295         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3296             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3297         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3298           return Result;
3299         // Never mind.
3300         CandidateSet.clear(
3301             OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3302 
3303         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3304         // arguments, not the entire list.
3305         Args = InitList->getInits();
3306         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3307         ListInitializing = true;
3308       }
3309 
3310       for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) {
3311         auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3312         if (!Info)
3313           continue;
3314 
3315         bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3316         if (ListInitializing)
3317           Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Info.Constructor->isExplicit());
3318         else
3319           Usable = Usable &&
3320                    Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3321         if (Usable) {
3322           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3323           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3324             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3325             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3326               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3327               // suppress conversions.
3328               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3329                   S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3330             }
3331           }
3332           if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3333             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
3334                 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3335                 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3336                 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3337           else
3338             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3339             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3340             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl,
3341                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3342                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3343         }
3344       }
3345     }
3346   }
3347 
3348   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3349   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3350   } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType())) {
3351     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3352   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
3353                                    = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3354     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3355          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3356       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3357       const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3358       for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
3359         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3360         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3361         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3362         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3363           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3364 
3365         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3366         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3367         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3368           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3369         else
3370           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3371 
3372         if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3373           if (ConvTemplate)
3374             S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3375                                              ActingContext, From, ToType,
3376                                              CandidateSet,
3377                                              AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3378           else
3379             S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3380                                      From, ToType, CandidateSet,
3381                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3382         }
3383       }
3384     }
3385   }
3386 
3387   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3388 
3389   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3390   switch (auto Result = CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(),
3391                                                         Best)) {
3392   case OR_Success:
3393   case OR_Deleted:
3394     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3395     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3396           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3397       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3398       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3399       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3400       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3401       //   the argument of the constructor.
3402       //
3403       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
3404       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3405         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3406         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3407       } else {
3408         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3409           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3410         else {
3411           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3412           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3413         }
3414       }
3415       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3416       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3417       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3418       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3419       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3420       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3421       return Result;
3422     }
3423     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3424                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3425       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3426       //
3427       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3428       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3429       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3430       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3431       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3432       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3433       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3434       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3435       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3436 
3437       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3438       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3439       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3440       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3441       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3442       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3443       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3444       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3445       //   13.3.3.1).
3446       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3447       return Result;
3448     }
3449     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3450 
3451   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3452     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3453 
3454   case OR_Ambiguous:
3455     return OR_Ambiguous;
3456   }
3457 
3458   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3459 }
3460 
3461 bool
3462 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3463   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3464   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3465                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3466   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3467     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3468                             CandidateSet, false, false);
3469   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3470     Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3471         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3472   else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
3473     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
3474                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3475                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3476       Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3477           << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3478   } else
3479     return false;
3480   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
3481   return true;
3482 }
3483 
3484 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3485 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3486 /// is possible.
3487 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3488 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3489                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3490   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
3491     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3492 
3493   // Objective-C++:
3494   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3495   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3496   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3497   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3498   //   to keep code working.
3499   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3500   if (!Conv1)
3501     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3502 
3503   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3504   if (!Conv2)
3505     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3506 
3507   if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3508     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3509     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3510     if (Block1 != Block2)
3511       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3512                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3513   }
3514 
3515   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3516 }
3517 
3518 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3519     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3520   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3521          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3522           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3523 }
3524 
3525 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3526 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3527 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3528 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3529 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3530                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3531                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3532 {
3533   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3534   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3535   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3536   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3537   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3538   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3539   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3540   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3541   //
3542   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3543   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3544   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3545   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3546   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3547 
3548   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3549   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3550   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3551   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3552   // standard. For example:
3553   //
3554   // int &f(...);    // #1
3555   // void f(char*);  // #2
3556   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3557   //
3558   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3559   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3560   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3561   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3562   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3563   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3564   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3565 
3566   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3567       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3568       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3569     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3570                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3571                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3572 
3573   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3574     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3575   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3576     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3577 
3578   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3579   // the same kind.
3580   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3581     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3582 
3583   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3584       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3585 
3586   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3587   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3588   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3589 
3590   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3591   // list-initialization sequence L2 if:
3592   // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or,
3593   //   if not that,
3594   // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T",
3595   //   and N1 is smaller than N2.,
3596   // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply.
3597   if (!ICS1.isBad()) {
3598     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3599         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3600       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3601     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3602         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3603       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3604   }
3605 
3606   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3607     // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than
3608     // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...]
3609     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3610                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3611   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3612     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3613     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3614     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3615     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3616     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3617     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3618     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3619           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3620       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3621                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3622                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3623     else
3624       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3625                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3626                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3627   }
3628 
3629   return Result;
3630 }
3631 
3632 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3633   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3634     Qualifiers Quals;
3635     T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
3636     T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
3637   }
3638 
3639   return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3640 }
3641 
3642 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3643 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3644 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3645 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3646                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3647                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3648   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3649     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3650 
3651   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3652   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3653   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3654     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3655   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3656     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3657 
3658   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3659     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3660       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3661     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3662       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3663     else
3664       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3665   } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3666     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3667 
3668   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3669     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3670                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3671   }
3672 
3673   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3674     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3675              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3676              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3677 
3678   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3679     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3680              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3681              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3682 
3683   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3684 }
3685 
3686 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3687 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3688 static bool
3689 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3690                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3691   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3692   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3693   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3694   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3695   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3696   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3697   //      reference*.
3698   //
3699   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3700   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3701   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3702   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3703   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3704   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3705       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3706     return false;
3707 
3708   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3709           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3710          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3711           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3712 }
3713 
3714 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3715 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3716 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3717 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3718 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3719                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3720                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3721 {
3722   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3723   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3724 
3725   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3726   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3727   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3728   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3729   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3730   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3731         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3732     return CK;
3733 
3734   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3735   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3736   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3737   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3738   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3739     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3740   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3741     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3742 
3743   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3744   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3745   // applies:
3746 
3747   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3748   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3749   //   that is such a conversion.
3750   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3751     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3752              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3753              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3754 
3755   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3756   //
3757   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3758   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3759   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3760   //   of B* to void*.
3761   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
3762     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
3763   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
3764     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
3765   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3766     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3767     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
3768     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3769                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3770   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3771     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3772     // their derived-to-base conversions.
3773     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
3774           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2))
3775       return DerivedCK;
3776   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3777              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
3778     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3779     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3780     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
3781     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3782     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
3783 
3784     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3785     // conversion, if we need to.
3786     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3787       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
3788     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3789       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
3790 
3791     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3792     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3793 
3794     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3795       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3796     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3797       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3798 
3799     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3800     // other, it is the better one.
3801     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3802       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3803     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3804       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3805     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3806       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3807                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
3808       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3809                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
3810       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3811         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3812                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3813       }
3814     }
3815   }
3816 
3817   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3818   // bullet 3).
3819   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
3820         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
3821     return QualCK;
3822 
3823   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
3824     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3825     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3826       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3827     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3828       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3829 
3830     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3831     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3832     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
3833     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3834     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3835     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
3836     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3837     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3838     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3839     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3840     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3841     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3842     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3843     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3844       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3845       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3846       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3847                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3848         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3849                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3850                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3851       }
3852 
3853       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3854       // type for comparison.
3855       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3856         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3857       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3858         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3859       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3860         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3861       else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3862         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3863     }
3864   }
3865 
3866   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3867   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3868   // is between types of the same size.
3869   // For example:
3870   // void f(float);
3871   // void f(int);
3872   // int main {
3873   //    long a;
3874   //    f(a);
3875   // }
3876   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3877   // as clang will do in standard mode.
3878   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3879       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3880       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3881           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3882     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3883 
3884   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3885 }
3886 
3887 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3888 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
3889 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3890 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3891 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3892                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3893                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3894   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
3895   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3896   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3897   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3898   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3899   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3900   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3901       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3902     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3903 
3904   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3905   // conversion (!)
3906   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3907   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3908   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3909   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3910   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3911   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3912   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3913 
3914   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3915   // them.
3916   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
3917     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3918 
3919   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3920   // for comparison.
3921   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3922     T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3923   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3924     T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3925 
3926   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3927     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3928 
3929   // Objective-C++ ARC:
3930   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3931   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3932   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3933                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3934     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3935                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3936                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3937   }
3938 
3939   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3940     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3941     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3942     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
3943     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
3944     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3945     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3946     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3947     // strict subset of qualifiers.
3948     if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3949       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3950       // about how the sequences rank.
3951       ;
3952     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3953       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3954       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3955         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3956         // qualifiers.
3957         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3958 
3959       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3960     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3961       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3962       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3963         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3964         // qualifiers.
3965         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3966 
3967       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3968     } else {
3969       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3970       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3971     }
3972 
3973     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
3974     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
3975       break;
3976   }
3977 
3978   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3979   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3980   switch (Result) {
3981   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
3982     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3983       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3984     break;
3985 
3986   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3987     break;
3988 
3989   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
3990     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3991       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3992     break;
3993   }
3994 
3995   return Result;
3996 }
3997 
3998 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3999 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4000 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
4001 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
4002 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
4003 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4004 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
4005                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4006                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4007   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4008   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
4009   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4010   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
4011 
4012   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4013   // conversion, if we need to.
4014   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4015     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4016   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4017     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4018 
4019   // Canonicalize all of the types.
4020   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
4021   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
4022   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
4023   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
4024 
4025   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
4026   //
4027   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
4028   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
4029   //
4030   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
4031   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4032       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4033       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
4034       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
4035       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
4036     QualType FromPointee1
4037       = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4038     QualType ToPointee1
4039       = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4040     QualType FromPointee2
4041       = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4042     QualType ToPointee2
4043       = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4044 
4045     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4046     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4047       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4048         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4049       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4050         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4051     }
4052 
4053     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4054     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
4055       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4056         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4057       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4058         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4059     }
4060   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4061              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4062     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
4063       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4064     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
4065       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4066     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
4067       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4068     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
4069       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4070 
4071     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
4072       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
4073       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
4074       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
4075       // Objective-C pointer types.
4076       bool FromAssignLeft
4077         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
4078       bool FromAssignRight
4079         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
4080       bool ToAssignLeft
4081         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
4082       bool ToAssignRight
4083         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
4084 
4085       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
4086       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
4087       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
4088           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4089         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4090       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
4091           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4092         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4093 
4094       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
4095       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
4096       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4097         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4098       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4099         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4100 
4101       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
4102       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
4103       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4104           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4105         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4106       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
4107           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4108         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4109 
4110       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
4111       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
4112       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4113         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4114       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4115         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4116 
4117       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4118       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4119           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4120           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) {
4121         if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) {
4122           // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to
4123           // C *.
4124           bool IsFirstSame =
4125               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl();
4126           bool IsSecondSame =
4127               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl();
4128           if (IsFirstSame) {
4129             if (!IsSecondSame)
4130               return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4131           } else if (IsSecondSame)
4132             return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4133         }
4134         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4135                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4136       }
4137 
4138       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4139       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
4140           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
4141         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4142         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4143     }
4144   }
4145 
4146   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
4147   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
4148       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
4149       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
4150     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
4151                                         FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4152     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
4153                                           ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4154     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
4155                                           FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4156     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
4157                                           ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4158     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
4159     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
4160     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
4161     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
4162     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4163     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4164     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4165     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4166     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
4167     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4168       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4169         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4170       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4171         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4172     }
4173     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
4174     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
4175       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4176         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4177       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4178         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4179     }
4180   }
4181 
4182   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4183     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
4184     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
4185     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4186     //      reference of type A&,
4187     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4188         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4189       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2))
4190         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4191       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1))
4192         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4193     }
4194 
4195     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
4196     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
4197     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4198     //      reference of type A&,
4199     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4200         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4201       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1))
4202         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4203       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2))
4204         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4205     }
4206   }
4207 
4208   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4209 }
4210 
4211 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
4212 /// C++ class.
4213 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
4214   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
4215     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
4216 
4217   return true;
4218 }
4219 
4220 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
4221 /// determine whether they are reference-related,
4222 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
4223 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
4224 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
4225 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
4226 /// type being initialized.
4227 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
4228 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
4229                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
4230                                    bool &DerivedToBase,
4231                                    bool &ObjCConversion,
4232                                    bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
4233   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
4234     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
4235   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
4236 
4237   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
4238   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
4239   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4240   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4241   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4242 
4243   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4244   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4245   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
4246   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4247   DerivedToBase = false;
4248   ObjCConversion = false;
4249   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4250   QualType ConvertedT2;
4251   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4252     // Nothing to do.
4253   } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) &&
4254              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4255              IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4256     DerivedToBase = true;
4257   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4258            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4259            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4260     ObjCConversion = true;
4261   else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() &&
4262            IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2))
4263     // C++1z [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4264     //   cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if [...] T2 is "noexcept
4265     //   function" and T1 is "function"
4266     //
4267     // We extend this to also apply to 'noreturn', so allow any function
4268     // conversion between function types.
4269     return Ref_Compatible;
4270   else
4271     return Ref_Incompatible;
4272 
4273   // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
4274   // least).
4275 
4276   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
4277   // for comparison.
4278   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4279     T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4280   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4281     T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4282 
4283   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4284   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
4285   //   reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
4286   //   as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
4287   //   overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
4288   //   cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
4289   //   reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
4290   //
4291   // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
4292   // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
4293   // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
4294   // space 2.
4295   if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4296       T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
4297     if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals))
4298       ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4299 
4300     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4301     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4302   }
4303 
4304   // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4305   T1Quals.removeUnaligned();
4306   T2Quals.removeUnaligned();
4307 
4308   if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4309     return Ref_Compatible;
4310   else
4311     return Ref_Related;
4312 }
4313 
4314 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible
4315 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4316 static bool
4317 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4318                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4319                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4320                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4321   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4322   CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4323     = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4324 
4325   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
4326       DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
4327   const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4328   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
4329     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4330     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4331     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4332       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4333 
4334     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4335       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4336     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4337     if (ConvTemplate)
4338       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4339     else
4340       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4341 
4342     // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
4343     // explicit conversions, skip it.
4344     if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4345       continue;
4346 
4347     if (AllowRvalues) {
4348       bool DerivedToBase = false;
4349       bool ObjCConversion = false;
4350       bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4351 
4352       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4353       // functions that return lvalues.
4354       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4355         const ReferenceType *RefType
4356           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4357         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4358           continue;
4359       }
4360 
4361       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4362           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4363             DeclLoc,
4364             Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4365               .getUnqualifiedType(),
4366             DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
4367             DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
4368           Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4369         continue;
4370     } else {
4371       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4372       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4373       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4374 
4375       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4376         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4377       if (!RefType ||
4378           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4379            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4380         continue;
4381     }
4382 
4383     if (ConvTemplate)
4384       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
4385                                        Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4386                                        /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4387     else
4388       S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
4389                                DeclType, CandidateSet,
4390                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4391   }
4392 
4393   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4394 
4395   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4396   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) {
4397   case OR_Success:
4398     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4399     //
4400     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4401     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4402     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4403     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4404     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4405     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4406     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4407     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4408     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4409       return false;
4410 
4411     ICS.setUserDefined();
4412     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4413     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4414     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4415     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4416     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4417     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4418     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4419            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4420            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4421     return true;
4422 
4423   case OR_Ambiguous:
4424     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4425     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4426          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4427       if (Cand->Viable)
4428         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
4429     return true;
4430 
4431   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4432   case OR_Deleted:
4433     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4434     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4435     return false;
4436   }
4437 
4438   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4439 }
4440 
4441 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4442 /// initialization.
4443 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4444 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4445                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4446                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4447                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4448   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4449 
4450   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4451   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4452   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4453 
4454   QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4455   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4456 
4457   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4458   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4459   // type of the resulting function.
4460   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4461     DeclAccessPair Found;
4462     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4463                                                                 false, Found))
4464       T2 = Fn->getType();
4465   }
4466 
4467   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4468   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4469   bool DerivedToBase = false;
4470   bool ObjCConversion = false;
4471   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4472   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4473   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4474     = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
4475                                      ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
4476 
4477 
4478   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4479   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4480   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4481 
4482   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4483   if (!isRValRef) {
4484     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4485     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4486     //
4487     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4488     if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) {
4489       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4490       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4491       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4492       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4493       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4494       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4495       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4496       ICS.setStandard();
4497       ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4498       ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4499                          : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4500                          : ICK_Identity;
4501       ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4502       ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4503       ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4504       ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4505       ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4506       ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4507       ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
4508       ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4509       ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4510       ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
4511       ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4512       ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
4513       ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4514       ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4515 
4516       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4517       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4518       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4519       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4520       return ICS;
4521     }
4522 
4523     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4524     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4525     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4526     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4527     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4528     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4529     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4530     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4531         S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4532         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4533       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4534                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4535                                    AllowExplicit))
4536         return ICS;
4537     }
4538   }
4539 
4540   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4541   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4542   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4543   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
4544     return ICS;
4545 
4546   //       -- If the initializer expression
4547   //
4548   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4549   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4550   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible &&
4551       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4552        (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4553        (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4554     ICS.setStandard();
4555     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4556     ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4557                       : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4558                       : ICK_Identity;
4559     ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4560     ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4561     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4562     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4563     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4564     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4565     // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4566     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4567     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4568     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4569     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4570     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
4571       S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4572       !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType());
4573     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4574     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4575     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4576     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4577     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
4578     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4579     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4580     return ICS;
4581   }
4582 
4583   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4584   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4585   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4586   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4587   //               "cv3 T3",
4588   //
4589   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4590   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4591   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4592   //          class subobject).
4593   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4594       T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4595       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4596                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4597                                AllowExplicit)) {
4598     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4599     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4600     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4601     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4602     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4603         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4604       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4605 
4606     return ICS;
4607   }
4608 
4609   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4610   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4611     return ICS;
4612 
4613   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4614   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4615   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4616   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4617   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4618   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4619   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4620   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4621     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4622     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4623     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4624     // initialization fails.
4625     //
4626     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4627     // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important.
4628     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4629     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4630     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4631     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4632     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4633     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4634     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4635     T1Quals.removeUnaligned();
4636     T2Quals.removeUnaligned();
4637     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4638       return ICS;
4639   }
4640 
4641   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4642   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4643   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4644   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4645   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4646   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4647       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4648     return ICS;
4649 
4650   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4651   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4652   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4653       isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4654     return ICS;
4655 
4656   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4657   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4658   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4659   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4660   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4661   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4662   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4663   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4664   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4665   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4666   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4667                               /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4668                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4669                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4670                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4671                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4672 
4673   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4674   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4675     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4676     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4677     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4678     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4679     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4680     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4681   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4682     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4683         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4684             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4685 
4686     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4687     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4688     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4689     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4690     //   lvalue.
4691     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4692     if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) {
4693       // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding
4694       // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue
4695       // reference to an rvalue!
4696       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4697       return ICS;
4698     }
4699 
4700     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4701     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4702     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4703     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4704     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4705     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4706   }
4707 
4708   return ICS;
4709 }
4710 
4711 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4712 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4713                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4714                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4715                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4716                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4717 
4718 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4719 /// initializer list From.
4720 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4721 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4722                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
4723                   bool InOverloadResolution,
4724                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4725   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4726   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4727   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4728 
4729   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4730   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
4731 
4732   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
4733   // initialized from init lists.
4734   if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType))
4735     return Result;
4736 
4737   // Per DR1467:
4738   //   If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single
4739   //   element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the
4740   //   implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element
4741   //   to the parameter type.
4742   //
4743   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ]
4744   //   and the initializer list has a single element that is an
4745   //   appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the
4746   //   implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion.
4747   if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4748     if (ToType->isRecordType()) {
4749       QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType();
4750       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) ||
4751           S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), InitType, ToType))
4752         return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4753                                      SuppressUserConversions,
4754                                      InOverloadResolution,
4755                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4756     }
4757     // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type,
4758     // initializer is a string literal.
4759     if (ToType->isArrayType()) {
4760       InitializedEntity Entity =
4761         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4762                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
4763       if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
4764         Result.setStandard();
4765         Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4766         Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4767         Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4768         return Result;
4769       }
4770     }
4771   }
4772 
4773   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below).
4774   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4775   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4776   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4777   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4778   //   element of the list to X.
4779   //
4780   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3:
4781   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer
4782   //   list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is
4783   //   default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list
4784   //   can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is
4785   //   the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X.
4786   //
4787   // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks.
4788   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
4789   QualType X;
4790   if (ToType->isArrayType())
4791     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
4792   else
4793     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
4794   if (!X.isNull()) {
4795     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4796       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4797       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4798           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4799                                 InOverloadResolution,
4800                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4801       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4802       if (ICS.isBad()) {
4803         Result = ICS;
4804         break;
4805       }
4806       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4807       if (Result.isBad() ||
4808           CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, From->getLocStart(), ICS,
4809                                              Result) ==
4810               ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4811         Result = ICS;
4812     }
4813 
4814     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4815     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4816     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4817       Result.setStandard();
4818       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4819       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4820       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4821     }
4822 
4823     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
4824     return Result;
4825   }
4826 
4827   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4:
4828   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4829   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4830   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4831   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4832   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4833   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
4834   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4835     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4836     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4837                                     /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4838                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4839                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4840                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4841   }
4842 
4843   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5:
4844   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4845   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4846   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4847   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
4848   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4849     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4850     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4851     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4852     // FIXME: Expose SemaInit's aggregate initialization code so that we don't
4853     // need to call into the initialization code here; overload resolution
4854     // should not be doing that.
4855     InitializedEntity Entity =
4856         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4857                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
4858     if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
4859       Result.setUserDefined();
4860       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4861       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4862       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4863       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4864 
4865       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4866       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4867       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4868       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
4869     }
4870     return Result;
4871   }
4872 
4873   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6:
4874   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4875   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
4876   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4877     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4878     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4879     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4880 
4881     QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4882 
4883     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4884     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4885     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4886       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4887 
4888       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4889 
4890       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4891       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4892       // type of the resulting function.
4893       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4894         DeclAccessPair Found;
4895         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4896                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
4897           T2 = Fn->getType();
4898       }
4899 
4900       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4901       bool dummy1 = false;
4902       bool dummy2 = false;
4903       bool dummy3 = false;
4904       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4905         = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4906                                          dummy2, dummy3);
4907 
4908       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
4909         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(),
4910                                 SuppressUserConversions,
4911                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4912       }
4913     }
4914 
4915     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4916     // initializer list.
4917     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4918                                InOverloadResolution,
4919                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4920     if (Result.isFailure())
4921       return Result;
4922     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4923            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4924 
4925     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4926     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4927         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4928       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4929                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
4930       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4931       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4932       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4933       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4934       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4935       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4936     } else
4937       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4938                     From, ToType);
4939     return Result;
4940   }
4941 
4942   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7:
4943   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4944   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4945   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4946     //    - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an
4947     //      initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one
4948     //      required to convert the element to the parameter type.
4949     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4950     if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0)))
4951       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4952                                      SuppressUserConversions,
4953                                      InOverloadResolution,
4954                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4955     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4956     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
4957     else if (NumInits == 0) {
4958       Result.setStandard();
4959       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4960       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4961       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4962     }
4963     return Result;
4964   }
4965 
4966   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8:
4967   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4968   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4969   return Result;
4970 }
4971 
4972 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4973 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4974 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4975 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
4976 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
4977 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
4978 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4979 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4980                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4981                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4982                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4983                       bool AllowExplicit) {
4984   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4985     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4986                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4987 
4988   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
4989     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
4990                             /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4991                             SuppressUserConversions,
4992                             AllowExplicit);
4993 
4994   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4995                                SuppressUserConversions,
4996                                /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4997                                InOverloadResolution,
4998                                /*CStyle=*/false,
4999                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5000                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5001 }
5002 
5003 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
5004                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
5005                                   Sema &S,
5006                                   SourceLocation Loc,
5007                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
5008   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
5009   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5010     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
5011 
5012   return !ICS.isBad();
5013 }
5014 
5015 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
5016 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
5017 /// expression @p From.
5018 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5019 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType,
5020                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
5021                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
5022                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
5023   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
5024   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
5025   //                 const volatile object.
5026   unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
5027     Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
5028   QualType ImplicitParamType =  S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
5029 
5030   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
5031   // to exit early.
5032   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
5033 
5034   // We need to have an object of class type.
5035   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5036     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
5037 
5038     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
5039     // better have an lvalue.
5040     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
5041   }
5042 
5043   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
5044 
5045   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
5046   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
5047   //   parameter is
5048   //
5049   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
5050   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
5051   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
5052   //        ref-qualifier
5053   //
5054   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
5055   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
5056   //
5057   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
5058   // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions
5059   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
5060   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
5061   // non-constant references.
5062 
5063   // First check the qualifiers.
5064   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
5065   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
5066                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
5067       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
5068     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5069                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5070     return ICS;
5071   }
5072 
5073   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
5074   // affects the conversion rank.
5075   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
5076   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
5077   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
5078     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
5079   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType))
5080     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
5081   else {
5082     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
5083                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5084     return ICS;
5085   }
5086 
5087   // Check the ref-qualifier.
5088   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
5089   case RQ_None:
5090     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
5091     break;
5092 
5093   case RQ_LValue:
5094     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
5095       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
5096       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
5097                  ImplicitParamType);
5098       return ICS;
5099     }
5100     break;
5101 
5102   case RQ_RValue:
5103     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
5104       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
5105       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
5106                  ImplicitParamType);
5107       return ICS;
5108     }
5109     break;
5110   }
5111 
5112   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
5113   ICS.setStandard();
5114   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5115   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
5116   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
5117   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
5118   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
5119   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
5120   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
5121   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5122   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
5123   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
5124     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
5125   return ICS;
5126 }
5127 
5128 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
5129 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
5130 /// expression.
5131 ExprResult
5132 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
5133                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
5134                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5135                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
5136   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
5137   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
5138     Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5139 
5140   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
5141   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5142     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
5143     DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
5144     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
5145   } else {
5146     FromRecordType = From->getType();
5147     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
5148     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
5149   }
5150 
5151   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
5152   // the actual argument initialization.
5153   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
5154       *this, From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method,
5155       Method->getParent());
5156   if (ICS.isBad()) {
5157     switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) {
5158     case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: {
5159       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
5160       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
5161       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
5162       if (CVR) {
5163         Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5164              diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
5165           << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
5166           << From->getSourceRange();
5167         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5168           << Method->getDeclName();
5169         return ExprError();
5170       }
5171       break;
5172     }
5173 
5174     case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue:
5175     case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: {
5176       bool IsRValueQualified =
5177         Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue;
5178       Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref)
5179         << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue()
5180         << IsRValueQualified;
5181       Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5182         << Method->getDeclName();
5183       return ExprError();
5184     }
5185 
5186     case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion:
5187     case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class:
5188       break;
5189     }
5190 
5191     return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5192                 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type)
5193        << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
5194   }
5195 
5196   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
5197     ExprResult FromRes =
5198       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
5199     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
5200       return ExprError();
5201     From = FromRes.get();
5202   }
5203 
5204   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
5205     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
5206                              From->getValueKind()).get();
5207   return From;
5208 }
5209 
5210 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
5211 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5212 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5213 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5214   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
5215                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5216                                /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5217                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5218                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5219                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5220                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5221 }
5222 
5223 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
5224 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5225 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
5226   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5227     return ExprError();
5228 
5229   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
5230   if (!ICS.isBad())
5231     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
5232 
5233   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
5234     return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5235                 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
5236                   << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
5237   return ExprError();
5238 }
5239 
5240 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
5241 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
5242 /// is acceptable.
5243 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
5244                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5245   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
5246   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
5247   // conversions are fine.
5248   switch (SCS.Second) {
5249   case ICK_Identity:
5250   case ICK_Function_Conversion:
5251   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
5252   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere.
5253   case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion:
5254     return true;
5255 
5256   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
5257     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
5258     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral
5259     // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression.
5260     //
5261     // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks
5262     // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this
5263     // (non-conforming) extension.
5264     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5265            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
5266 
5267   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
5268   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
5269     // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are
5270     // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t.
5271     return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType();
5272 
5273   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
5274   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
5275   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
5276   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
5277   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
5278   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
5279   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
5280   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
5281   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
5282   case ICK_Complex_Real:
5283   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
5284   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
5285   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
5286   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
5287   case ICK_C_Only_Conversion:
5288   case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion:
5289     return false;
5290 
5291   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
5292   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
5293   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
5294     llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second");
5295 
5296   case ICK_Qualification:
5297     llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second");
5298 
5299   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
5300     break;
5301   }
5302 
5303   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
5304 }
5305 
5306 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
5307 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
5308 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
5309 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From,
5310                                                    QualType T, APValue &Value,
5311                                                    Sema::CCEKind CCE,
5312                                                    bool RequireInt) {
5313   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
5314          "converted constant expression outside C++11");
5315 
5316   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From))
5317     return ExprError();
5318 
5319   // C++1z [expr.const]p3:
5320   //  A converted constant expression of type T is an expression,
5321   //  implicitly converted to type T, where the converted
5322   //  expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion
5323   //  sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...].
5324   // C++1z [stmt.if]p2:
5325   //  If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the
5326   //  condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type
5327   //  bool.
5328   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5329       CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf
5330           ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From)
5331           : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T,
5332                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5333                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5334                                   /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false,
5335                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5336   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5337   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5338   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5339     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5340     break;
5341   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5342     // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence
5343     // must be trivial.
5344     SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5345     break;
5346   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5347   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5348     if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5349       return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5350                     diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5351                 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5352     return ExprError();
5353 
5354   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5355     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5356   }
5357 
5358   // Check that we would only use permitted conversions.
5359   if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) {
5360     return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5361                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5362              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5363   }
5364   // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly.
5365   if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) {
5366     return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5367                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect)
5368              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5369   }
5370 
5371   ExprResult Result =
5372       S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting);
5373   if (Result.isInvalid())
5374     return Result;
5375 
5376   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5377   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5378   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5379   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5380                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5381   case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
5382     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
5383     // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
5384   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5385     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5386     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5387   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5388     break;
5389 
5390   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5391     S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5392       << CCE << /*Constant*/1
5393       << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5394     break;
5395 
5396   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5397     S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5398       << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5399     break;
5400   }
5401 
5402   if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) {
5403     Value = APValue();
5404     return Result;
5405   }
5406 
5407   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5408   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5409   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5410   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5411   Expr::ConstExprUsage Usage = CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg
5412                                    ? Expr::EvaluateForMangling
5413                                    : Expr::EvaluateForCodeGen;
5414 
5415   if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, Usage, S.Context) ||
5416       (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) {
5417     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5418     // the AST.
5419     Result = ExprError();
5420   } else {
5421     Value = Eval.Val;
5422 
5423     if (Notes.empty()) {
5424       // It's a constant expression.
5425       return Result;
5426     }
5427   }
5428 
5429   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5430   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5431       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5432     S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5433   else {
5434     S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5435       << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5436     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5437       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5438   }
5439   return ExprError();
5440 }
5441 
5442 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5443                                                   APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) {
5444   return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false);
5445 }
5446 
5447 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5448                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
5449                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
5450   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
5451 
5452   APValue V;
5453   auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true);
5454   if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent())
5455     Value = V.getInt();
5456   return R;
5457 }
5458 
5459 
5460 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5461 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5462 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5463 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5464   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5465     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5466     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5467     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5468   }
5469 }
5470 
5471 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5472 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5473 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5474 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5475   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5476   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5477   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5478     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5479                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5480                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5481                             /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5482                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5483                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5484                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5485                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5486 
5487   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5488   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5489   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5490   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5491   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5492     break;
5493 
5494   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5495     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5496     break;
5497 
5498   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5499     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5500     break;
5501   }
5502 
5503   return ICS;
5504 }
5505 
5506 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5507 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5508 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists.
5509 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5510   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5511     return ExprError();
5512 
5513   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5514   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5515     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5516   if (!ICS.isBad())
5517     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5518   return ExprResult();
5519 }
5520 
5521 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5522 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5523 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5524   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5525                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5526 }
5527 
5528 static ExprResult
5529 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5530                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5531                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5532 
5533   if (Converter.Suppress)
5534     return ExprError();
5535 
5536   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5537   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5538     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5539         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5540     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5541     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5542   }
5543   return From;
5544 }
5545 
5546 static bool
5547 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5548                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5549                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5550                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5551   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5552     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5553     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5554         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5555 
5556     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5557     // conversion; use it.
5558     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5559     std::string TypeStr;
5560     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5561 
5562     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5563         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5564                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5565         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5566                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
5567     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5568 
5569     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5570     // explicit conversion function.
5571     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5572       return true;
5573 
5574     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5575     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5576                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5577     if (Result.isInvalid())
5578       return true;
5579     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5580     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5581                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5582                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
5583   }
5584   return false;
5585 }
5586 
5587 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5588                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5589                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5590                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5591   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5592       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5593   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5594 
5595   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5596   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5597     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5598       return true;
5599 
5600     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5601         << From->getSourceRange();
5602   }
5603 
5604   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5605                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5606   if (Result.isInvalid())
5607     return true;
5608   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5609   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5610                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5611                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
5612   return false;
5613 }
5614 
5615 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5616     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5617     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5618   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5619     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5620         << From->getSourceRange();
5621 
5622   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5623 }
5624 
5625 static void
5626 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5627                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5628                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5629   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5630     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5631     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5632     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5633     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5634       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5635 
5636     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5637     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5638     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5639       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5640     else
5641       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5642 
5643     if (ConvTemplate)
5644       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
5645         ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
5646         /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5647     else
5648       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
5649                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
5650                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5651   }
5652 }
5653 
5654 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5655 /// by the given converter.
5656 ///
5657 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5658 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5659 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5660 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5661 /// one target type.
5662 ///
5663 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5664 /// conversion.
5665 ///
5666 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
5667 ///
5668 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
5669 ///
5670 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5671 /// successful.
5672 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5673     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5674   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5675   if (From->isTypeDependent())
5676     return From;
5677 
5678   // Process placeholders immediately.
5679   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5680     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5681     if (result.isInvalid())
5682       return result;
5683     From = result.get();
5684   }
5685 
5686   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
5687   QualType T = From->getType();
5688   if (Converter.match(T))
5689     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5690 
5691   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5692 
5693   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5694   // type.
5695   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
5696   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5697     if (!Converter.Suppress)
5698       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5699     return From;
5700   }
5701 
5702   // We must have a complete class type.
5703   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
5704     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
5705     Expr *From;
5706 
5707     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5708         : Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5709 
5710     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
5711       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5712     }
5713   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
5714 
5715   if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T)
5716                          : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
5717     return From;
5718 
5719   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5720   UnresolvedSet<4>
5721       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
5722   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
5723   const auto &Conversions =
5724       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5725 
5726   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5727       (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1);
5728 
5729   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5730   QualType ToType;
5731   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5732 
5733   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5734   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
5735     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5736     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5737     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5738     if (ConvTemplate) {
5739       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
5740         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5741       else
5742         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5743     } else
5744       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5745 
5746     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
5747            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5748            "viable in C++1y");
5749 
5750     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5751     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5752 
5753       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5754         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5755         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5756         if (!ConvTemplate)
5757           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5758       } else {
5759         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
5760           if (ToType.isNull())
5761             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5762           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5763                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5764             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5765         }
5766         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5767       }
5768     }
5769   }
5770 
5771   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
5772     // C++1y [conv]p6:
5773     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5774     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5775     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5776     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
5777     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5778     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
5779     // exactly one such T.
5780 
5781     // If no unique T is found:
5782     if (ToType.isNull()) {
5783       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5784                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5785                                      ExplicitConversions))
5786         return ExprError();
5787       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
5788     }
5789 
5790     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5791     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5792       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5793                                          ViableConversions);
5794 
5795     // If one unique T is found:
5796     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5797     // potentially viable conversions.
5798     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
5799     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5800                                       CandidateSet);
5801 
5802     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5803     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5804     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5805     case OR_Success: {
5806       // Apply this conversion.
5807       DeclAccessPair Found =
5808           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5809       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5810                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5811         return ExprError();
5812       break;
5813     }
5814     case OR_Ambiguous:
5815       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5816                                          ViableConversions);
5817     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5818       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5819                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5820                                      ExplicitConversions))
5821         return ExprError();
5822       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
5823     case OR_Deleted:
5824       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5825       break;
5826     }
5827   } else {
5828     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5829     case 0: {
5830       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5831                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5832                                      ExplicitConversions))
5833         return ExprError();
5834 
5835       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5836       break;
5837     }
5838     case 1: {
5839       // Apply this conversion.
5840       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5841       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5842                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5843         return ExprError();
5844       break;
5845     }
5846     default:
5847       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5848                                          ViableConversions);
5849     }
5850   }
5851 
5852   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
5853 }
5854 
5855 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
5856 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
5857 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
5858 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
5859 /// enumeration types.
5860 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
5861                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
5862                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
5863   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
5864   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
5865 
5866   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
5867     return true;
5868 
5869   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
5870     return true;
5871 
5872   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5873   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
5874     return false;
5875 
5876   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
5877     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
5878     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
5879       return true;
5880   }
5881 
5882   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
5883     return false;
5884 
5885   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
5886     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
5887     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
5888       return true;
5889   }
5890 
5891   return false;
5892 }
5893 
5894 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
5895 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
5896 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5897 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
5898 ///
5899 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
5900 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5901 /// code completion.
5902 void
5903 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
5904                            DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5905                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5906                            OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
5907                            bool SuppressUserConversions,
5908                            bool PartialOverloading,
5909                            bool AllowExplicit,
5910                            ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions) {
5911   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
5912     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
5913   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
5914   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5915          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
5916 
5917   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
5918     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5919       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5920       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5921       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5922       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
5923       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5924       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5925       // is irrelevant.
5926       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(),
5927                          Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args,
5928                          CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
5929                          PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions);
5930       return;
5931     }
5932     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5933     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
5934   }
5935 
5936   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
5937     return;
5938 
5939   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5940   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
5941   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
5942   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
5943   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
5944   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
5945   //   candidate functions.
5946   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
5947       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
5948     return;
5949 
5950   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
5951   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
5952   //   overload resolution.
5953   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
5954   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
5955       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
5956     return;
5957 
5958   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
5959   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
5960       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
5961 
5962   // Add this candidate
5963   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
5964       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions);
5965   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5966   Candidate.Function = Function;
5967   Candidate.Viable = true;
5968   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5969   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
5970   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
5971 
5972   if (Function->isMultiVersion() &&
5973       !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
5974     Candidate.Viable = false;
5975     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
5976     return;
5977   }
5978 
5979   if (Constructor) {
5980     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5981     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5982     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
5983     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
5984     if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
5985         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5986          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getLocStart(), Args[0]->getType(),
5987                        ClassType))) {
5988       Candidate.Viable = false;
5989       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor;
5990       return;
5991     }
5992 
5993     // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution)
5994     //   A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter
5995     //   of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated
5996     //   from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when
5997     //   constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly
5998     //   one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related
5999     //   to C.
6000     auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl());
6001     if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 &&
6002         Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6003       QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType();
6004       QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent());
6005       QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent());
6006       SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc();
6007       if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) &&
6008           (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) {
6009         Candidate.Viable = false;
6010         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice;
6011         return;
6012       }
6013     }
6014   }
6015 
6016   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6017 
6018   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6019   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6020   // list (8.3.5).
6021   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6022       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6023     Candidate.Viable = false;
6024     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6025     return;
6026   }
6027 
6028   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6029   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6030   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6031   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6032   // exactly m parameters.
6033   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
6034   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6035     // Not enough arguments.
6036     Candidate.Viable = false;
6037     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6038     return;
6039   }
6040 
6041   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6042   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6043     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6044       // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this
6045       // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is
6046       // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of
6047       // the class.
6048       if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) {
6049         Candidate.Viable = false;
6050         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6051         return;
6052       }
6053 
6054   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6055   // arguments.
6056   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6057     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isInitialized()) {
6058       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6059       // template argument deduction.
6060     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6061       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6062       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6063       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6064       // parameter of F.
6065       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6066       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6067         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6068                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6069                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6070                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6071                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6072                                 AllowExplicit);
6073       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
6074         Candidate.Viable = false;
6075         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6076         return;
6077       }
6078     } else {
6079       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6080       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6081       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6082       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
6083     }
6084   }
6085 
6086   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) {
6087     Candidate.Viable = false;
6088     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6089     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6090     return;
6091   }
6092 
6093   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) {
6094     Candidate.Viable = false;
6095     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled;
6096     return;
6097   }
6098 }
6099 
6100 ObjCMethodDecl *
6101 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance,
6102                        SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) {
6103   if (Methods.size() <= 1)
6104     return nullptr;
6105 
6106   for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6107     bool Match = true;
6108     ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
6109     unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
6110     // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
6111     // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
6112     if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
6113       NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
6114     if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
6115       continue;
6116 
6117     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
6118       // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
6119       if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6120         Match = false;
6121         break;
6122       }
6123 
6124       ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
6125       Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
6126       assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
6127 
6128       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
6129       // a consumed argument.
6130       if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
6131           !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
6132         argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
6133 
6134       // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
6135       if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6136         Match = false;
6137         break;
6138       }
6139 
6140       ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
6141         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
6142                                 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
6143                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6144                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6145                                 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6146                                 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
6147       // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider
6148       // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here.
6149       if (ConversionState.isBad() ||
6150           (ConversionState.isStandard() &&
6151            ConversionState.Standard.Second ==
6152                ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) {
6153         Match = false;
6154         break;
6155       }
6156     }
6157     // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
6158     if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
6159       for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
6160         if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6161           Match = false;
6162           break;
6163         }
6164         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
6165                                                           nullptr);
6166         if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
6167           Match = false;
6168           break;
6169         }
6170       }
6171     } else {
6172       // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
6173       if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
6174         Match = false;
6175       else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
6176         // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
6177         // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
6178         for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6179           QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
6180           if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
6181             return Methods[b];
6182         }
6183       }
6184     }
6185 
6186     if (Match)
6187       return Method;
6188   }
6189   return nullptr;
6190 }
6191 
6192 static bool
6193 convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg,
6194                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap,
6195                                  bool MissingImplicitThis, Expr *&ConvertedThis,
6196                                  SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) {
6197   if (ThisArg) {
6198     CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
6199     assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6200            "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!");
6201     assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!");
6202     ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(
6203         ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method);
6204     if (R.isInvalid())
6205       return false;
6206     ConvertedThis = R.get();
6207   } else {
6208     if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6209       (void)MD;
6210       assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() ||
6211               isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) &&
6212              "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods");
6213     }
6214     ConvertedThis = nullptr;
6215   }
6216 
6217   // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the
6218   // user can't refer to them in the function condition.
6219   unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size());
6220 
6221   // Convert the arguments.
6222   for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) {
6223     ExprResult R;
6224     R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6225                                         S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)),
6226                                     SourceLocation(), Args[I]);
6227 
6228     if (R.isInvalid())
6229       return false;
6230 
6231     ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6232   }
6233 
6234   if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6235     return false;
6236 
6237   // Push default arguments if needed.
6238   if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) {
6239     for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
6240       ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i);
6241       Expr *DefArg = P->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()
6242                          ? P->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg()
6243                          : P->getDefaultArg();
6244       // This can only happen in code completion, i.e. when PartialOverloading
6245       // is true.
6246       if (!DefArg)
6247         return false;
6248       ExprResult R =
6249           S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6250                                           S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(i)),
6251                                       SourceLocation(), DefArg);
6252       if (R.isInvalid())
6253         return false;
6254       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6255     }
6256 
6257     if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6258       return false;
6259   }
6260   return true;
6261 }
6262 
6263 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6264                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
6265   auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6266 
6267   if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end())
6268     return nullptr;
6269 
6270   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
6271   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
6272   // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed.
6273   Expr *DiscardedThis;
6274   if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6275           *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, Args, Trap,
6276           /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs))
6277     return *EnableIfAttrs.begin();
6278 
6279   for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) {
6280     APValue Result;
6281     // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is
6282     // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully.
6283     if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6284             Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs)))
6285       return EIA;
6286 
6287     if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue())
6288       return EIA;
6289   }
6290   return nullptr;
6291 }
6292 
6293 template <typename CheckFn>
6294 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND,
6295                                         bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc,
6296                                         CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) {
6297   SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs;
6298   for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) {
6299     if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent())
6300       Attrs.push_back(DIA);
6301   }
6302 
6303   // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early.
6304   if (Attrs.empty())
6305     return false;
6306 
6307   auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition(
6308       Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
6309       [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); });
6310 
6311   // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the
6312   // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes).
6313   auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin),
6314                                IsSuccessful);
6315   if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) {
6316     const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr;
6317     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6318     S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6319         << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6320     return true;
6321   }
6322 
6323   for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end()))
6324     if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) {
6325       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6326       S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6327           << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6328     }
6329 
6330   return false;
6331 }
6332 
6333 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function,
6334                                                const Expr *ThisArg,
6335                                                ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
6336                                                SourceLocation Loc) {
6337   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6338       *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc,
6339       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6340         APValue Result;
6341         // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since
6342         // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each
6343         // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to.
6344         if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6345                 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg))
6346           return false;
6347         return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue();
6348       });
6349 }
6350 
6351 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND,
6352                                                  SourceLocation Loc) {
6353   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6354       *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc,
6355       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6356         bool Result;
6357         return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) &&
6358                Result;
6359       });
6360 }
6361 
6362 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
6363 /// the overload candidate set.
6364 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
6365                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6366                                  OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6367                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6368                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6369                                  bool PartialOverloading,
6370                                  bool FirstArgumentIsBase) {
6371   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
6372     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
6373     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
6374 
6375     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6376     FunctionDecl *FD =
6377         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
6378 
6379     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) {
6380       QualType ObjectType;
6381       Expr::Classification ObjectClassification;
6382       if (Args.size() > 0) {
6383         if (Expr *E = Args[0]) {
6384           // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup:
6385           ObjectType = E->getType();
6386           ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context);
6387         } // .. else there is an implicit base.
6388         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6389       }
6390       if (FunTmpl) {
6391         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
6392             FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6393             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
6394             ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6395             FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6396             PartialOverloading);
6397       } else {
6398         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
6399                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType,
6400                            ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6401                            SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6402       }
6403     } else {
6404       // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods.
6405 
6406       // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access
6407       // static method as non-static.
6408       if (Args.size() > 0 &&
6409           (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
6410                         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) {
6411         assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic());
6412         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6413       }
6414       if (FunTmpl) {
6415         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
6416             FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs,
6417             CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6418       } else {
6419         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6420                              SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6421       }
6422     }
6423   }
6424 }
6425 
6426 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
6427 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
6428 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6429                               QualType ObjectType,
6430                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6431                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6432                               OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6433                               bool SuppressUserConversions) {
6434   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6435   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
6436 
6437   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
6438     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
6439 
6440   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
6441     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6442            "Expected a member function template");
6443     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6444                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType,
6445                                ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6446                                SuppressUserConversions);
6447   } else {
6448     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6449                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6450                        SuppressUserConversions);
6451   }
6452 }
6453 
6454 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
6455 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
6456 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
6457 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
6458 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
6459 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
6460 /// operators.
6461 void
6462 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6463                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6464                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6465                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6466                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6467                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
6468                          bool PartialOverloading,
6469                          ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions) {
6470   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6471     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6472   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6473   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6474          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
6475 
6476   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
6477     return;
6478 
6479   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
6480   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
6481   //   ignored by overload resolution.
6482   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
6483       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6484     return;
6485 
6486   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6487   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6488       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6489 
6490   // Add this candidate
6491   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6492       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions);
6493   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6494   Candidate.Function = Method;
6495   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6496   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6497   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6498 
6499   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6500 
6501   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6502   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6503   // list (8.3.5).
6504   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6505       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6506     Candidate.Viable = false;
6507     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6508     return;
6509   }
6510 
6511   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6512   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6513   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6514   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6515   // exactly m parameters.
6516   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
6517   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6518     // Not enough arguments.
6519     Candidate.Viable = false;
6520     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6521     return;
6522   }
6523 
6524   Candidate.Viable = true;
6525 
6526   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
6527     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
6528     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
6529   else {
6530     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
6531     // parameter.
6532     Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6533         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6534         Method, ActingContext);
6535     if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
6536       Candidate.Viable = false;
6537       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6538       return;
6539     }
6540   }
6541 
6542   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6543   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6544     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6545       if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) {
6546         Candidate.Viable = false;
6547         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6548         return;
6549       }
6550 
6551   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6552   // arguments.
6553   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6554     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isInitialized()) {
6555       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6556       // template argument deduction.
6557     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6558       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6559       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6560       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6561       // parameter of F.
6562       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6563       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
6564         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6565                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6566                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6567                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6568                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6569       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
6570         Candidate.Viable = false;
6571         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6572         return;
6573       }
6574     } else {
6575       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6576       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6577       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6578       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
6579     }
6580   }
6581 
6582   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
6583     Candidate.Viable = false;
6584     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6585     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6586     return;
6587   }
6588 
6589   if (Method->isMultiVersion() &&
6590       !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6591     Candidate.Viable = false;
6592     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6593   }
6594 }
6595 
6596 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
6597 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
6598 /// function template specialization.
6599 void
6600 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
6601                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6602                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6603                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6604                                  QualType ObjectType,
6605                                  Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6606                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6607                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6608                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6609                                  bool PartialOverloading) {
6610   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
6611     return;
6612 
6613   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
6614   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
6615   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
6616   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
6617   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6618   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6619   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6620   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6621   //   functions.
6622   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6623   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6624   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
6625   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
6626           MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
6627           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
6628             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
6629                 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
6630                 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType,
6631                 ObjectClassification);
6632           })) {
6633     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6634         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
6635     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6636     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
6637     Candidate.Viable = false;
6638     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6639     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
6640         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() ||
6641         ObjectType.isNull();
6642     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6643     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
6644       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6645     else {
6646       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6647       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6648                                                             Info);
6649     }
6650     return;
6651   }
6652 
6653   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6654   // deduction as a candidate.
6655   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
6656   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
6657          "Specialization is not a member function?");
6658   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
6659                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
6660                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading,
6661                      Conversions);
6662 }
6663 
6664 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
6665 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
6666 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
6667 void
6668 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
6669                                    DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6670                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6671                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6672                                    OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6673                                    bool SuppressUserConversions,
6674                                    bool PartialOverloading) {
6675   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6676     return;
6677 
6678   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
6679   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
6680   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
6681   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
6682   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6683   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6684   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6685   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6686   //   functions.
6687   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6688   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6689   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
6690   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
6691           FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
6692           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
6693             return CheckNonDependentConversions(FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes,
6694                                                 Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
6695                                                 SuppressUserConversions);
6696           })) {
6697     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6698         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
6699     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6700     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6701     Candidate.Viable = false;
6702     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6703     // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object
6704     // type.
6705     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
6706         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) &&
6707         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function);
6708     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6709     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
6710       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6711     else {
6712       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6713       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6714                                                             Info);
6715     }
6716     return;
6717   }
6718 
6719   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6720   // deduction as a candidate.
6721   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
6722   AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
6723                        SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading,
6724                        /*AllowExplicit*/false, Conversions);
6725 }
6726 
6727 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument
6728 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's
6729 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10.
6730 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions(
6731     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes,
6732     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6733     ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions,
6734     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6735     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification) {
6736   // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor
6737   // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear
6738   // that is correct.
6739   const bool AllowExplicit = false;
6740 
6741   auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6742   auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
6743   bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method);
6744   unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0;
6745 
6746   Conversions =
6747       CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size());
6748 
6749   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6750   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6751       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6752 
6753   // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't
6754   // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and
6755   // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations.
6756   if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() &&
6757       !ObjectType.isNull()) {
6758     Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6759         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6760         Method, ActingContext);
6761     if (Conversions[0].isBad())
6762       return true;
6763   }
6764 
6765   for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N;
6766        ++I) {
6767     QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I];
6768     if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) {
6769       Conversions[ThisConversions + I]
6770         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType,
6771                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6772                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6773                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6774                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6775                                 AllowExplicit);
6776       if (Conversions[ThisConversions + I].isBad())
6777         return true;
6778     }
6779   }
6780 
6781   return false;
6782 }
6783 
6784 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
6785 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
6786 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
6787 ///
6788 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
6789 ///
6790 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
6791 ///
6792 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
6793 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
6794 ///
6795 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
6796 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
6797                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
6798                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
6799   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
6800 
6801   // Easy case: the types are the same.
6802   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
6803     return true;
6804 
6805   // Allow qualification conversions.
6806   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
6807   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
6808                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
6809     return true;
6810 
6811   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
6812   // we're done.
6813   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
6814     return false;
6815 
6816   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
6817   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
6818   QualType ConvertedType;
6819   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
6820                                    IncompatibleObjC);
6821 }
6822 
6823 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
6824 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
6825 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
6826 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
6827 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
6828 /// conversion function produces).
6829 void
6830 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
6831                              DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6832                              CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6833                              Expr *From, QualType ToType,
6834                              OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6835                              bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
6836                              bool AllowResultConversion) {
6837   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6838          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
6839   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6840   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6841     return;
6842 
6843   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
6844   // deduction now.
6845   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
6846     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
6847       return;
6848     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6849   }
6850 
6851   // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion
6852   // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T.
6853   if (!AllowResultConversion &&
6854       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType))
6855     return;
6856 
6857   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
6858   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
6859   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
6860   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
6861       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
6862                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
6863     return;
6864 
6865   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6866   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6867       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6868 
6869   // Add this candidate
6870   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
6871   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6872   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
6873   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6874   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6875   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
6876   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
6877   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
6878   Candidate.Viable = true;
6879   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
6880 
6881   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
6882   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
6883   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
6884   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
6885   //
6886   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6887   // object parameter.
6888   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
6889   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
6890     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
6891   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
6892     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
6893 
6894   Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6895       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(),
6896       From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext);
6897 
6898   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
6899     Candidate.Viable = false;
6900     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6901     return;
6902   }
6903 
6904   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
6905   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
6906   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
6907   QualType FromCanon
6908     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
6909   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
6910   if (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
6911       IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
6912     Candidate.Viable = false;
6913     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
6914     return;
6915   }
6916 
6917   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
6918   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
6919   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
6920   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
6921   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
6922   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
6923   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
6924   // well-formed.
6925   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
6926                             VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
6927   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
6928                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
6929                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
6930                                 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
6931 
6932   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
6933   if (!isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType)) {
6934     Candidate.Viable = false;
6935     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6936     return;
6937   }
6938 
6939   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
6940 
6941   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
6942   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
6943   // allocator).
6944   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
6945   CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
6946                 From->getLocStart());
6947   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
6948     TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
6949                           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
6950                           /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6951                           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
6952 
6953   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
6954   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
6955     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
6956 
6957     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
6958     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
6959     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
6960     //   shall have exact match rank.
6961     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6962         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
6963       Candidate.Viable = false;
6964       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
6965       return;
6966     }
6967 
6968     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
6969     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
6970     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
6971     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
6972     //    program is ill-formed.
6973     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
6974         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
6975       Candidate.Viable = false;
6976       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6977       return;
6978     }
6979     break;
6980 
6981   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
6982     Candidate.Viable = false;
6983     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6984     return;
6985 
6986   default:
6987     llvm_unreachable(
6988            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
6989   }
6990 
6991   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
6992     Candidate.Viable = false;
6993     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6994     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6995     return;
6996   }
6997 
6998   if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() &&
6999       !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
7000     Candidate.Viable = false;
7001     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7002   }
7003 }
7004 
7005 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization
7006 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
7007 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
7008 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
7009 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
7010 void
7011 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
7012                                      DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7013                                      CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
7014                                      Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7015                                      OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7016                                      bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7017                                      bool AllowResultConversion) {
7018   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
7019          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
7020 
7021   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
7022     return;
7023 
7024   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7025   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7026   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7027         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
7028                                   Specialization, Info)) {
7029     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7030     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7031     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7032     Candidate.Viable = false;
7033     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7034     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7035     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7036     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7037     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7038                                                           Info);
7039     return;
7040   }
7041 
7042   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
7043   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
7044   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7045   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
7046                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7047                          AllowResultConversion);
7048 }
7049 
7050 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
7051 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
7052 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
7053 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
7054 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
7055 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
7056                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7057                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7058                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
7059                                  Expr *Object,
7060                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7061                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
7062   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7063     return;
7064 
7065   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7066   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7067       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7068 
7069   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
7070   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7071   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7072   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
7073   Candidate.Viable = true;
7074   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
7075   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7076   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7077 
7078   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7079   // object parameter.
7080   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7081       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(),
7082       Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext);
7083   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
7084     Candidate.Viable = false;
7085     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7086     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
7087     return;
7088   }
7089 
7090   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
7091   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
7092   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
7093   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
7094   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
7095   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
7096   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
7097   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
7098   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
7099   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
7100     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
7101   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
7102 
7103   // Find the
7104   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
7105 
7106   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
7107   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
7108   // list (8.3.5).
7109   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
7110     Candidate.Viable = false;
7111     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
7112     return;
7113   }
7114 
7115   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
7116   // we have enough arguments.
7117   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
7118     // Not enough arguments.
7119     Candidate.Viable = false;
7120     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
7121     return;
7122   }
7123 
7124   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7125   // arguments.
7126   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7127     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
7128       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
7129       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
7130       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
7131       // parameter of F.
7132       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
7133       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
7134         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
7135                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7136                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7137                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7138                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7139       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
7140         Candidate.Viable = false;
7141         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7142         return;
7143       }
7144     } else {
7145       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
7146       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
7147       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
7148       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
7149     }
7150   }
7151 
7152   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
7153     Candidate.Viable = false;
7154     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7155     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7156     return;
7157   }
7158 }
7159 
7160 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
7161 /// member functions.
7162 ///
7163 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
7164 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
7165 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
7166 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
7167 /// [over.match.oper]).
7168 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7169                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
7170                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7171                                        OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
7172                                        SourceRange OpRange) {
7173   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7174 
7175   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7176   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
7177   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
7178   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
7179   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
7180   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
7181   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
7182   //   constructed as follows:
7183   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
7184 
7185   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
7186   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
7187   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
7188   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
7189   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7190     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
7191     if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined())
7192       return;
7193     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
7194     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
7195       return;
7196 
7197     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7198     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
7199     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
7200 
7201     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
7202                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
7203          Oper != OperEnd;
7204          ++Oper)
7205       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
7206                          Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
7207                          CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
7208   }
7209 }
7210 
7211 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
7212 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
7213 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
7214 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
7215 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
7216 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
7217 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
7218 /// converted to bool.
7219 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7220                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
7221                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
7222                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7223   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7224   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7225       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7226 
7227   // Add this candidate
7228   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
7229   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
7230   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7231   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7232   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7233   std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes);
7234 
7235   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7236   // arguments.
7237   Candidate.Viable = true;
7238   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7239   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7240     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
7241     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
7242     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
7243     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
7244     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
7245     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
7246     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
7247     //
7248     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
7249     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
7250     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
7251     // is not of the same type.
7252     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7253       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
7254              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
7255       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7256         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
7257     } else {
7258       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7259         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
7260                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
7261                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7262                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7263                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7264     }
7265     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
7266       Candidate.Viable = false;
7267       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7268       break;
7269     }
7270   }
7271 }
7272 
7273 namespace {
7274 
7275 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
7276 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
7277 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
7278 /// enumeration types.
7279 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
7280   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
7281   typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>,
7282                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet;
7283 
7284   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
7285   /// built-in candidates.
7286   TypeSet PointerTypes;
7287 
7288   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
7289   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7290   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
7291 
7292   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
7293   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7294   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
7295 
7296   /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
7297   /// candidates.
7298   TypeSet VectorTypes;
7299 
7300   /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
7301   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
7302 
7303   /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
7304   /// were present in the candidate set.
7305   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
7306 
7307   /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
7308   /// candidate set.
7309   bool HasNullPtrType;
7310 
7311   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
7312   /// candidate type set.
7313   Sema &SemaRef;
7314 
7315   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
7316   ASTContext &Context;
7317 
7318   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7319                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
7320   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
7321 
7322 public:
7323   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
7324   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
7325 
7326   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
7327     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
7328       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
7329       HasNullPtrType(false),
7330       SemaRef(SemaRef),
7331       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
7332 
7333   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7334                              SourceLocation Loc,
7335                              bool AllowUserConversions,
7336                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7337                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
7338 
7339   /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
7340   iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
7341 
7342   /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
7343   iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
7344 
7345   /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
7346   iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
7347 
7348   /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
7349   iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
7350 
7351   /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
7352   iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
7353 
7354   /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
7355   iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
7356 
7357   iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
7358   iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
7359 
7360   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
7361   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
7362   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
7363 };
7364 
7365 } // end anonymous namespace
7366 
7367 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
7368 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7369 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7370 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7371 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7372 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7373 /// false otherwise.
7374 ///
7375 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7376 bool
7377 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7378                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7379 
7380   // Insert this type.
7381   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7382     return false;
7383 
7384   QualType PointeeTy;
7385   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
7386   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
7387   if (!PointerTy) {
7388     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7389     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7390     buildObjCPtr = true;
7391   } else {
7392     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7393   }
7394 
7395   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7396   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7397   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7398   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7399   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7400     return true;
7401 
7402   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7403   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
7404   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
7405 
7406   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
7407   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7408     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7409     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
7410     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
7411 
7412     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
7413     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
7414     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
7415         (!hasRestrict ||
7416          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
7417       continue;
7418 
7419     // Build qualified pointee type.
7420     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7421 
7422     // Build qualified pointer type.
7423     QualType QPointerTy;
7424     if (!buildObjCPtr)
7425       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7426     else
7427       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7428 
7429     // Insert qualified pointer type.
7430     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
7431   }
7432 
7433   return true;
7434 }
7435 
7436 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
7437 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7438 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7439 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7440 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7441 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7442 /// false otherwise.
7443 ///
7444 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7445 bool
7446 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
7447     QualType Ty) {
7448   // Insert this type.
7449   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7450     return false;
7451 
7452   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
7453   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
7454 
7455   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7456   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7457   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7458   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7459   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7460   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7461     return true;
7462   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
7463 
7464   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
7465   // qualifiers.
7466   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7467   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7468     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7469 
7470     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7471     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
7472       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
7473   }
7474 
7475   return true;
7476 }
7477 
7478 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
7479 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
7480 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
7481 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
7482 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
7483 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
7484 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
7485 /// type.
7486 void
7487 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7488                                                SourceLocation Loc,
7489                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
7490                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7491                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7492   // Only deal with canonical types.
7493   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
7494 
7495   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
7496   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
7497   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7498     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
7499 
7500   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
7501   if (Ty->isArrayType())
7502     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
7503 
7504   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
7505   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
7506 
7507   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
7508   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
7509   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
7510 
7511   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
7512   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
7513     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
7514 
7515   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
7516     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
7517   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
7518     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
7519     // of types.
7520     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
7521       return;
7522   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
7523     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
7524     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
7525       return;
7526   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
7527     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
7528     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
7529   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
7530     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
7531     // extension.
7532     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
7533     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
7534   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
7535     HasNullPtrType = true;
7536   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
7537     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
7538     if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty))
7539       return;
7540 
7541     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
7542     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
7543       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
7544         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
7545 
7546       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
7547       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
7548       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
7549         continue;
7550 
7551       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
7552       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
7553         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
7554                               VisibleQuals);
7555       }
7556     }
7557   }
7558 }
7559 
7560 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
7561 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
7562 /// given type to the candidate set.
7563 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
7564                                                    QualType T,
7565                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7566                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
7567   QualType ParamTypes[2];
7568 
7569   // T& operator=(T&, T)
7570   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7571   ParamTypes[1] = T;
7572   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7573                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
7574 
7575   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
7576     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
7577     ParamTypes[0]
7578       = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
7579     ParamTypes[1] = T;
7580     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7581                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
7582   }
7583 }
7584 
7585 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
7586 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
7587 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
7588     Qualifiers VRQuals;
7589     const RecordType *TyRec;
7590     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
7591         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7592       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
7593     else
7594       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
7595     if (!TyRec) {
7596       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
7597       VRQuals.addVolatile();
7598       VRQuals.addRestrict();
7599       return VRQuals;
7600     }
7601 
7602     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
7603     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
7604       return VRQuals;
7605 
7606     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
7607       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
7608         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
7609       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
7610         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
7611         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7612           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7613         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
7614         // as see them.
7615         bool done = false;
7616         while (!done) {
7617           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
7618             VRQuals.addRestrict();
7619           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7620             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7621           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
7622                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7623             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
7624           else
7625             done = true;
7626           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
7627             VRQuals.addVolatile();
7628           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
7629             return VRQuals;
7630         }
7631       }
7632     }
7633     return VRQuals;
7634 }
7635 
7636 namespace {
7637 
7638 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
7639 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
7640 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
7641 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
7642 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
7643   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
7644   Sema &S;
7645   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
7646   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7647   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
7648   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
7649   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
7650 
7651   static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24;
7652   SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes;
7653 
7654   // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithemetic types in
7655   // ArithmeticTypes.  The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
7656   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
7657   unsigned FirstIntegralType,
7658            LastIntegralType;
7659   unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType,
7660            LastPromotedIntegralType;
7661   unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType,
7662            LastPromotedArithmeticType;
7663   unsigned NumArithmeticTypes;
7664 
7665   void InitArithmeticTypes() {
7666     // Start of promoted types.
7667     FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0;
7668     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy);
7669     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy);
7670     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy);
7671     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type())
7672       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty);
7673 
7674     // Start of integral types.
7675     FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
7676     FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
7677     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy);
7678     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy);
7679     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy);
7680     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
7681       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty);
7682     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy);
7683     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy);
7684     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy);
7685     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
7686       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty);
7687     LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
7688     LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
7689     // End of promoted types.
7690 
7691     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy);
7692     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy);
7693     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy);
7694     if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8)
7695       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty);
7696     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty);
7697     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty);
7698     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy);
7699     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy);
7700     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy);
7701     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy);
7702     LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
7703     NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size();
7704     // End of integral types.
7705     // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
7706 
7707     assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap &&
7708            "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types.");
7709   }
7710 
7711   /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
7712   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
7713   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
7714                                            bool HasVolatile,
7715                                            bool HasRestrict) {
7716     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7717       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
7718       S.Context.IntTy
7719     };
7720 
7721     // Non-volatile version.
7722     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7723 
7724     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
7725     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
7726     if (HasVolatile) {
7727       ParamTypes[0] =
7728         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7729           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
7730       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7731     }
7732 
7733     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
7734     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
7735     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
7736         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
7737       ParamTypes[0]
7738         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7739             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
7740       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7741 
7742       if (HasVolatile) {
7743         ParamTypes[0]
7744           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7745               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
7746                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7747                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7748         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7749       }
7750     }
7751 
7752   }
7753 
7754 public:
7755   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
7756     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7757     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
7758     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
7759     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
7760     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
7761     : S(S), Args(Args),
7762       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
7763       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
7764         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
7765       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
7766       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
7767 
7768     InitArithmeticTypes();
7769   }
7770 
7771   // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17.
7772   //
7773   // C++ [over.built]p3:
7774   //
7775   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
7776   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
7777   //   candidate operator functions of the form
7778   //
7779   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
7780   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
7781   //
7782   // C++ [over.built]p4:
7783   //
7784   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
7785   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
7786   //   candidate operator functions of the form
7787   //
7788   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
7789   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
7790   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7791     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7792       return;
7793 
7794     for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
7795       const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
7796       if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) {
7797         if (Op == OO_MinusMinus)
7798           continue;
7799         if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)
7800           continue;
7801       }
7802       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
7803         TypeOfT,
7804         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
7805         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
7806     }
7807   }
7808 
7809   // C++ [over.built]p5:
7810   //
7811   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7812   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
7813   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7814   //
7815   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
7816   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
7817   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
7818   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
7819   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
7820     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7821               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7822            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7823          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7824       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
7825       if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7826         continue;
7827 
7828       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
7829         (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7830          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
7831         (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7832          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
7833     }
7834   }
7835 
7836   // C++ [over.built]p6:
7837   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
7838   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7839   //
7840   //       T&         operator*(T*);
7841   //
7842   // C++ [over.built]p7:
7843   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
7844   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7845   //       T&         operator*(T*);
7846   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
7847     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7848               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7849            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7850          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7851       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7852       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
7853       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
7854         continue;
7855 
7856       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
7857         if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
7858           continue;
7859 
7860       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7861     }
7862   }
7863 
7864   // C++ [over.built]p9:
7865   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
7866   //  operator functions of the form
7867   //
7868   //       T         operator+(T);
7869   //       T         operator-(T);
7870   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
7871     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7872       return;
7873 
7874     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7875          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
7876       QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
7877       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7878     }
7879 
7880     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
7881     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7882               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7883            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7884          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7885       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
7886       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7887     }
7888   }
7889 
7890   // C++ [over.built]p8:
7891   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
7892   //   the form
7893   //
7894   //       T*         operator+(T*);
7895   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
7896     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7897               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7898            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7899          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7900       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7901       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7902     }
7903   }
7904 
7905   // C++ [over.built]p10:
7906   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
7907   //   operator functions of the form
7908   //
7909   //        T         operator~(T);
7910   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
7911     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7912       return;
7913 
7914     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7915          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
7916       QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int];
7917       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7918     }
7919 
7920     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
7921     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7922               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7923            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7924          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7925       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
7926       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7927     }
7928   }
7929 
7930   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
7931   //   For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there
7932   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7933   //
7934   //        bool operator==(T,T);
7935   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
7936   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() {
7937     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7938     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7939 
7940     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7941       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7942                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7943              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7944            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
7945            ++MemPtr) {
7946         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7947         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
7948           continue;
7949 
7950         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7951         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7952       }
7953 
7954       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7955         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7956         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) {
7957           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
7958           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7959         }
7960       }
7961     }
7962   }
7963 
7964   // C++ [over.built]p15:
7965   //
7966   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type,
7967   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7968   //
7969   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
7970   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
7971   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
7972   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
7973   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
7974   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
7975   //           R       operator<=>(T, T)
7976   void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7977     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7978     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7979     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7980     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7981     //   candidate.
7982     //
7983     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7984     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7985     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7986     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
7987     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7988     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7989     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7990       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7991 
7992     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7993       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7994           CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7995         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7996                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7997              C != CEnd; ++C) {
7998           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7999             continue;
8000 
8001           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
8002             continue;
8003 
8004           QualType FirstParamType =
8005             C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
8006           QualType SecondParamType =
8007             C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
8008 
8009           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
8010           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
8011               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
8012             continue;
8013 
8014           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
8015           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
8016             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
8017                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
8018         }
8019       }
8020     }
8021 
8022     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8023     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8024 
8025     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8026       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8027                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
8028              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
8029            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8030         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8031         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8032           continue;
8033 
8034         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
8035         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8036       }
8037       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8038                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8039              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8040            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8041         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
8042 
8043         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
8044         // candidate exists.
8045         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second ||
8046             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
8047                                                             CanonType)))
8048           continue;
8049         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
8050         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8051       }
8052     }
8053   }
8054 
8055   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8056   //
8057   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
8058   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8059   //
8060   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8061   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
8062   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8063   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8064   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
8065   //
8066   // C++ [over.built]p14:
8067   //
8068   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
8069   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8070   //
8071   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
8072   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8073     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8074     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8075 
8076     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
8077       QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = {
8078         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8079         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8080       };
8081       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8082                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
8083              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
8084            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8085         QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
8086         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
8087           continue;
8088 
8089         AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
8090         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
8091           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
8092           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8093           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8094         }
8095         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
8096           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
8097           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8098             continue;
8099 
8100           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
8101           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8102         }
8103       }
8104     }
8105   }
8106 
8107   // C++ [over.built]p12:
8108   //
8109   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
8110   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8111   //
8112   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
8113   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
8114   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
8115   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
8116   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
8117   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
8118   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
8119   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
8120   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
8121   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
8122   //
8123   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8124   //   between types L and R.
8125   //
8126   // C++ [over.built]p24:
8127   //
8128   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
8129   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8130   //
8131   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
8132   //
8133   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8134   //   between types L and R.
8135   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
8136   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8137     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8138       return;
8139 
8140     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8141          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
8142       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8143            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8144         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8145                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8146         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8147       }
8148     }
8149 
8150     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
8151     // conditional operator for vector types.
8152     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8153               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
8154            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
8155          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
8156       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8157                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
8158              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
8159            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
8160         QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
8161         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8162       }
8163     }
8164   }
8165 
8166   // C++2a [over.built]p14:
8167   //
8168   //   For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function
8169   //   of the form
8170   //
8171   //        std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T)
8172   //
8173   // C++2a [over.built]p15:
8174   //
8175   //   For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate
8176   //   operator function of the form
8177   //
8178   //       std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R);
8179   //
8180   // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with
8181   // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum
8182   // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during
8183   // overload resolution. For example:
8184   //
8185   //   enum A : int {a};
8186   //   auto x = (a <=> (long)42);
8187   //
8188   //   error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'.
8189   //   note: candidate operator<=>(int, int)
8190   //   note: candidate operator<=>(long, long)
8191   //
8192   // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds
8193   // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted
8194   // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads).
8195   //
8196   // For now this function acts as a placeholder.
8197   void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() {
8198     addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8199   }
8200 
8201   // C++ [over.built]p17:
8202   //
8203   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
8204   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8205   //
8206   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
8207   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
8208   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
8209   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
8210   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
8211   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
8212   //
8213   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8214   //   between types L and R.
8215   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8216     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8217       return;
8218 
8219     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8220          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
8221       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8222            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8223         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8224                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8225         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8226       }
8227     }
8228   }
8229 
8230   // C++ [over.built]p20:
8231   //
8232   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
8233   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
8234   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8235   //
8236   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
8237   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8238     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8239     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8240 
8241     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8242       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8243                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8244              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8245            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8246         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second)
8247           continue;
8248 
8249         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
8250       }
8251 
8252       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8253                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8254              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8255            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8256         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
8257           continue;
8258 
8259         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
8260       }
8261     }
8262   }
8263 
8264   // C++ [over.built]p19:
8265   //
8266   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
8267   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
8268   //   of the form
8269   //
8270   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
8271   //
8272   // C++ [over.built]p21:
8273   //
8274   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8275   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
8276   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8277   //
8278   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8279   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8280   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8281     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8282     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8283 
8284     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8285               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8286            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8287          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8288       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
8289       if (isEqualOp)
8290         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
8291       else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8292         continue;
8293 
8294       // non-volatile version
8295       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8296         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
8297         isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8298       };
8299       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8300                             /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
8301 
8302       bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
8303                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8304       if (NeedVolatile) {
8305         // volatile version
8306         ParamTypes[0] =
8307           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
8308         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8309                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8310       }
8311 
8312       if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
8313           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8314         // restrict version
8315         ParamTypes[0]
8316           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
8317         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8318                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8319 
8320         if (NeedVolatile) {
8321           // volatile restrict version
8322           ParamTypes[0]
8323             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8324                 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
8325                                               (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8326                                                Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8327           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8328                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8329         }
8330       }
8331     }
8332 
8333     if (isEqualOp) {
8334       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8335                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
8336              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
8337            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8338         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
8339         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8340           continue;
8341 
8342         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8343           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
8344           *Ptr,
8345         };
8346 
8347         // non-volatile version
8348         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8349                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
8350 
8351         bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
8352                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8353         if (NeedVolatile) {
8354           // volatile version
8355           ParamTypes[0] =
8356             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
8357           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8358                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
8359         }
8360 
8361         if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
8362             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8363           // restrict version
8364           ParamTypes[0]
8365             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
8366           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8367                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
8368 
8369           if (NeedVolatile) {
8370             // volatile restrict version
8371             ParamTypes[0]
8372               = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8373                   S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
8374                                                 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8375                                                  Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8376             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8377                                   /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
8378           }
8379         }
8380       }
8381     }
8382   }
8383 
8384   // C++ [over.built]p18:
8385   //
8386   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
8387   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
8388   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
8389   //   the form
8390   //
8391   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
8392   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
8393   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
8394   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
8395   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
8396   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8397     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8398       return;
8399 
8400     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
8401       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8402            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8403         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8404         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8405 
8406         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8407         ParamTypes[0] =
8408           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
8409         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8410                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8411 
8412         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8413         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8414           ParamTypes[0] =
8415             S.Context.getVolatileType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
8416           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8417           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8418                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8419         }
8420       }
8421     }
8422 
8423     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
8424     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8425               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
8426            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
8427          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
8428       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8429                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
8430              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
8431            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
8432         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8433         ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
8434         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8435         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
8436         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8437                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8438 
8439         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8440         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8441           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
8442           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8443           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8444                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8445         }
8446       }
8447     }
8448   }
8449 
8450   // C++ [over.built]p22:
8451   //
8452   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
8453   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
8454   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8455   //
8456   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
8457   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
8458   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
8459   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
8460   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
8461   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
8462   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
8463     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8464       return;
8465 
8466     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
8467       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8468            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8469         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8470         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8471 
8472         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8473         ParamTypes[0] =
8474           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
8475         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8476         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8477           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8478           ParamTypes[0] = ArithmeticTypes[Left];
8479           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
8480           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8481           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8482         }
8483       }
8484     }
8485   }
8486 
8487   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
8488   //
8489   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
8490   //
8491   //        bool        operator!(bool);
8492   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
8493   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
8494   void addExclaimOverload() {
8495     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
8496     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
8497                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8498                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
8499   }
8500   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
8501     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
8502     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8503                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8504                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
8505   }
8506 
8507   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8508   //
8509   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
8510   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8511   //
8512   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8513   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
8514   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8515   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
8516   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
8517   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
8518     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8519               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8520            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8521          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8522       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
8523       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
8524       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
8525         continue;
8526 
8527       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
8528       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8529     }
8530 
8531     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8532               Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
8533            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
8534          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8535       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
8536       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
8537       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
8538         continue;
8539 
8540       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
8541       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8542     }
8543   }
8544 
8545   // C++ [over.built]p11:
8546   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
8547   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
8548   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
8549   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8550   //
8551   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
8552   //
8553   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
8554   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
8555     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8556              Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8557            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8558          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8559       QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
8560       QualType C1;
8561       QualifierCollector Q1;
8562       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
8563       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
8564         continue;
8565       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
8566       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
8567       // volatile/restrict type.
8568       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
8569         continue;
8570       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
8571         continue;
8572       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8573                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
8574              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
8575            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8576         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
8577         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
8578         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
8579         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2))
8580           break;
8581         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
8582         // build CV12 T&
8583         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
8584         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
8585             T.isVolatileQualified())
8586           continue;
8587         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
8588             T.isRestrictQualified())
8589           continue;
8590         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
8591         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8592       }
8593     }
8594   }
8595 
8596   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
8597   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
8598   // therefore added as binary.
8599   //
8600   // C++ [over.built]p25:
8601   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
8602   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8603   //
8604   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
8605   //
8606   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
8607     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8608     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8609 
8610     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8611       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8612                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
8613              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
8614            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8615         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8616           continue;
8617 
8618         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
8619         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8620       }
8621 
8622       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8623                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8624              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8625            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8626         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
8627           continue;
8628 
8629         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
8630         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8631       }
8632 
8633       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
8634         for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8635                   Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8636                EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8637              Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8638           if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
8639             continue;
8640 
8641           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second)
8642             continue;
8643 
8644           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
8645           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8646         }
8647       }
8648     }
8649   }
8650 };
8651 
8652 } // end anonymous namespace
8653 
8654 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
8655 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
8656 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
8657 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
8658 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
8659 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8660                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
8661                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8662                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
8663   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
8664   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
8665   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
8666   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
8667   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8668   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
8669   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
8670     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
8671 
8672   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
8673   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
8674   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
8675   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8676     CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this);
8677     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
8678                                                  OpLoc,
8679                                                  true,
8680                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
8681                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
8682                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
8683                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
8684     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
8685         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
8686     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
8687         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
8688         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
8689   }
8690 
8691   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
8692   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
8693   //
8694   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
8695   // 'bool' overloads.
8696   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
8697       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
8698     return;
8699 
8700   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
8701   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
8702                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
8703                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
8704                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
8705 
8706   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
8707   switch (Op) {
8708   case OO_None:
8709   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
8710     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
8711 
8712   case OO_New:
8713   case OO_Delete:
8714   case OO_Array_New:
8715   case OO_Array_Delete:
8716   case OO_Call:
8717     llvm_unreachable(
8718                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
8719 
8720   case OO_Comma:
8721   case OO_Arrow:
8722   case OO_Coawait:
8723     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8724     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the
8725     //      operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the
8726     //      built-in candidates set is empty.
8727     break;
8728 
8729   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
8730     if (Args.size() == 1)
8731       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
8732     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
8733 
8734   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
8735     if (Args.size() == 1) {
8736       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
8737     } else {
8738       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
8739       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8740     }
8741     break;
8742 
8743   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
8744     if (Args.size() == 1)
8745       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
8746     else
8747       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8748     break;
8749 
8750   case OO_Slash:
8751     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8752     break;
8753 
8754   case OO_PlusPlus:
8755   case OO_MinusMinus:
8756     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8757     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
8758     break;
8759 
8760   case OO_EqualEqual:
8761   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
8762     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads();
8763     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
8764 
8765   case OO_Less:
8766   case OO_Greater:
8767   case OO_LessEqual:
8768   case OO_GreaterEqual:
8769     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8770     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8771     break;
8772 
8773   case OO_Spaceship:
8774     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8775     OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads();
8776     break;
8777 
8778   case OO_Percent:
8779   case OO_Caret:
8780   case OO_Pipe:
8781   case OO_LessLess:
8782   case OO_GreaterGreater:
8783     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8784     break;
8785 
8786   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
8787     if (Args.size() == 1)
8788       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8789       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8790       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
8791       break;
8792 
8793     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8794     break;
8795 
8796   case OO_Tilde:
8797     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
8798     break;
8799 
8800   case OO_Equal:
8801     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8802     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
8803 
8804   case OO_PlusEqual:
8805   case OO_MinusEqual:
8806     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
8807     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
8808 
8809   case OO_StarEqual:
8810   case OO_SlashEqual:
8811     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
8812     break;
8813 
8814   case OO_PercentEqual:
8815   case OO_LessLessEqual:
8816   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
8817   case OO_AmpEqual:
8818   case OO_CaretEqual:
8819   case OO_PipeEqual:
8820     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
8821     break;
8822 
8823   case OO_Exclaim:
8824     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
8825     break;
8826 
8827   case OO_AmpAmp:
8828   case OO_PipePipe:
8829     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
8830     break;
8831 
8832   case OO_Subscript:
8833     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
8834     break;
8835 
8836   case OO_ArrowStar:
8837     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
8838     break;
8839 
8840   case OO_Conditional:
8841     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
8842     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8843     break;
8844   }
8845 }
8846 
8847 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
8848 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
8849 ///
8850 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
8851 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
8852 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
8853 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
8854 void
8855 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
8856                                            SourceLocation Loc,
8857                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8858                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8859                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
8860                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
8861   ADLResult Fns;
8862 
8863   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
8864   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
8865   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
8866   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
8867   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
8868   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
8869 
8870   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
8871   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
8872 
8873   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
8874   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
8875                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8876        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
8877     if (Cand->Function) {
8878       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
8879       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
8880         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
8881     }
8882 
8883   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
8884   // set.
8885   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8886     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
8887     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
8888       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
8889         continue;
8890 
8891       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
8892                            PartialOverloading);
8893     } else
8894       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
8895                                    FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8896                                    Args, CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
8897   }
8898 }
8899 
8900 namespace {
8901 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse };
8902 }
8903 
8904 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of
8905 /// overload resolution.
8906 ///
8907 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff
8908 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as
8909 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if
8910 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes.
8911 ///
8912 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if
8913 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are
8914 /// worse than Cand1's.
8915 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1,
8916                                        const FunctionDecl *Cand2) {
8917   // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs.
8918   bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
8919   bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
8920   if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) {
8921     if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr)
8922       return Comparison::Equal;
8923     return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse;
8924   }
8925 
8926   auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
8927   auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
8928 
8929   auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin();
8930   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
8931   for (auto Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) {
8932     Cand1ID.clear();
8933     Cand2ID.clear();
8934 
8935     // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1
8936     // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2.
8937     if (Cand1I == Cand1Attrs.end())
8938       return Comparison::Worse;
8939     auto Cand1A = Cand1I++;
8940 
8941     Cand1A->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
8942     Cand2A->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
8943     if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
8944       return Comparison::Worse;
8945   }
8946 
8947   return Cand1I == Cand1Attrs.end() ? Comparison::Equal : Comparison::Better;
8948 }
8949 
8950 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
8951 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
8952 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(
8953     Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
8954     SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) {
8955   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
8956   // functions.
8957   if (!Cand2.Viable)
8958     return Cand1.Viable;
8959   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
8960     return false;
8961 
8962   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8963   //
8964   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
8965   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
8966   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
8967   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
8968   unsigned StartArg = 0;
8969   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
8970     StartArg = 1;
8971 
8972   auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
8973     // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++.
8974     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8975       return ICS.isStandard() &&
8976              ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
8977 
8978     // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to
8979     // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11.
8980     return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
8981            hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS);
8982   };
8983 
8984   // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given
8985   // argument to be better candidates than functions that do.
8986   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
8987   assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
8988   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
8989   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
8990     bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
8991     bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
8992     if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) {
8993       if (Cand1Bad)
8994         return false;
8995       HasBetterConversion = true;
8996     }
8997   }
8998 
8999   if (HasBetterConversion)
9000     return true;
9001 
9002   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9003   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
9004   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
9005   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
9006   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9007     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9008                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
9009                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
9010     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9011       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
9012       HasBetterConversion = true;
9013       break;
9014 
9015     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9016       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
9017       return false;
9018 
9019     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9020       // Do nothing.
9021       break;
9022     }
9023   }
9024 
9025   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
9026   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
9027   if (HasBetterConversion)
9028     return true;
9029 
9030   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
9031   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
9032   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
9033   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
9034   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
9035   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
9036   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion &&
9037       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9038       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
9039       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
9040     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
9041     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
9042     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
9043     // pointer or block.
9044     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
9045         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9046     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9047       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9048                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
9049                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
9050 
9051     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9052       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
9053 
9054     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
9055     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
9056     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
9057   }
9058 
9059   // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording,
9060   // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243.
9061   //
9062   // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or
9063   // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over
9064   // a conversion function.
9065   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 &&
9066       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9067       isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) !=
9068           isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function))
9069     return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9070 
9071   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
9072   //       specialization, or, if not that,
9073   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
9074                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9075   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
9076                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9077   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
9078     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
9079 
9080   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
9081   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
9082   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
9083   //      if not that,
9084   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
9085     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
9086           = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
9087                                          Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
9088                                          Loc,
9089                        isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
9090                                                              : TPOC_Call,
9091                                          Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments,
9092                                          Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments))
9093       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9094   }
9095 
9096   // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 inheriting constructor wording.
9097   // A derived-class constructor beats an (inherited) base class constructor.
9098   bool Cand1IsInherited =
9099       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9100   bool Cand2IsInherited =
9101       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9102   if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited)
9103     return Cand2IsInherited;
9104   else if (Cand1IsInherited) {
9105     assert(Cand2IsInherited);
9106     auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext());
9107     auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext());
9108     if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class))
9109       return true;
9110     if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class))
9111       return false;
9112     // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous.
9113   }
9114 
9115   // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides.
9116   {
9117     auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9118     auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function);
9119     if (Guide1 && Guide2) {
9120       //  -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not
9121       if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit())
9122         return Guide2->isImplicit();
9123 
9124       //  -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not
9125       if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate())
9126         return true;
9127     }
9128   }
9129 
9130   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
9131   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9132     Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9133     if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal)
9134       return Cmp == Comparison::Better;
9135   }
9136 
9137   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9138     FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9139     return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) >
9140            S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9141   }
9142 
9143   bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr &&
9144                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function);
9145   bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr &&
9146                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function);
9147   return HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1;
9148 }
9149 
9150 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of
9151 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no
9152 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including
9153 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to
9154 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both
9155 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using
9156 /// a modularized libstdc++).
9157 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
9158                                                   const NamedDecl *B) {
9159   auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A);
9160   auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B);
9161   if (!VA || !VB)
9162     return false;
9163 
9164   // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage
9165   // entity in different modules.
9166   if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
9167           VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) ||
9168       getOwningModule(const_cast<ValueDecl *>(VA)) ==
9169           getOwningModule(const_cast<ValueDecl *>(VB)) ||
9170       VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible())
9171     return false;
9172 
9173   // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent.
9174   //
9175   // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity.
9176   // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is
9177   // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all.
9178   if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType()))
9179     return true;
9180 
9181   // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but
9182   // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes.
9183   if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) {
9184     if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) {
9185       // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and
9186       // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type.
9187       auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext());
9188       auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext());
9189       if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() ||
9190           !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(),
9191                                EnumB->getIntegerType()))
9192         return false;
9193       // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators.
9194       return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal());
9195     }
9196   }
9197 
9198   // Nothing else is sufficiently similar.
9199   return false;
9200 }
9201 
9202 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(
9203     SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) {
9204   Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D;
9205 
9206   Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(D));
9207   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9208       << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9209 
9210   for (auto *E : Equiv) {
9211     Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(E));
9212     Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9213         << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9214   }
9215 }
9216 
9217 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
9218 /// within an overload candidate set.
9219 ///
9220 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
9221 /// which overload resolution occurs.
9222 ///
9223 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
9224 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
9225 ///
9226 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
9227 OverloadingResult
9228 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9229                                          iterator &Best) {
9230   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates;
9231   std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates),
9232                  [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; });
9233 
9234   // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but
9235   // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular
9236   // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to
9237   // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based
9238   // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one
9239   // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore
9240   // the WrongSide candidate.
9241   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) {
9242     const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9243     bool ContainsSameSideCandidate =
9244         llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9245           return Cand->Function &&
9246                  S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9247                      Sema::CFP_SameSide;
9248         });
9249     if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) {
9250       auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9251         return Cand->Function &&
9252                S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9253                    Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9254       };
9255       llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate);
9256     }
9257   }
9258 
9259   // Find the best viable function.
9260   Best = end();
9261   for (auto *Cand : Candidates)
9262     if (Cand->Viable)
9263       if (Best == end() ||
9264           isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind))
9265         Best = Cand;
9266 
9267   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
9268   if (Best == end())
9269     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
9270 
9271   llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands;
9272 
9273   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
9274   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
9275   for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
9276     if (Cand->Viable && Cand != Best &&
9277         !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) {
9278       if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Best->Function,
9279                                                    Cand->Function)) {
9280         EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function);
9281         continue;
9282       }
9283 
9284       Best = end();
9285       return OR_Ambiguous;
9286     }
9287   }
9288 
9289   // Best is the best viable function.
9290   if (Best->Function &&
9291       (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
9292        S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
9293     return OR_Deleted;
9294 
9295   if (!EquivalentCands.empty())
9296     S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function,
9297                                                     EquivalentCands);
9298 
9299   return OR_Success;
9300 }
9301 
9302 namespace {
9303 
9304 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
9305   oc_function,
9306   oc_method,
9307   oc_constructor,
9308   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
9309   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
9310   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
9311   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
9312   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
9313   oc_inherited_constructor
9314 };
9315 
9316 enum OverloadCandidateSelect {
9317   ocs_non_template,
9318   ocs_template,
9319   ocs_described_template,
9320 };
9321 
9322 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect>
9323 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
9324                           std::string &Description) {
9325 
9326   bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl();
9327   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
9328     isTemplate = true;
9329     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
9330         FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
9331   }
9332 
9333   OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() {
9334     if (!Description.empty())
9335       return ocs_described_template;
9336     return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template;
9337   }();
9338 
9339   OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() {
9340     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
9341       if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) {
9342         if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found))
9343           return oc_inherited_constructor;
9344         else
9345           return oc_constructor;
9346       }
9347 
9348       if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
9349         return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
9350 
9351       if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
9352         return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
9353 
9354       assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
9355              "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
9356       return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
9357     }
9358 
9359     if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9360       // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
9361       // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
9362       if (!Meth->isImplicit())
9363         return oc_method;
9364 
9365       if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
9366         return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
9367 
9368       if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
9369         return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
9370 
9371       assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
9372       return oc_method;
9373     }
9374 
9375     return oc_function;
9376   }();
9377 
9378   return std::make_pair(Kind, Select);
9379 }
9380 
9381 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) {
9382   // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload
9383   // set.
9384   if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl))
9385     S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(),
9386            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor)
9387       << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass();
9388 }
9389 
9390 } // end anonymous namespace
9391 
9392 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx,
9393                                     const FunctionDecl *FD) {
9394   for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) {
9395     bool AlwaysTrue;
9396     if (!EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx))
9397       return false;
9398     if (!AlwaysTrue)
9399       return false;
9400   }
9401   return true;
9402 }
9403 
9404 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function.
9405 ///
9406 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic
9407 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are
9408 ///   we in overload resolution?
9409 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored
9410 ///   if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution.
9411 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD,
9412                                               bool Complain,
9413                                               bool InOverloadResolution,
9414                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
9415   if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) {
9416     if (Complain) {
9417       if (InOverloadResolution)
9418         S.Diag(FD->getLocStart(),
9419                diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr);
9420       else
9421         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD;
9422     }
9423     return false;
9424   }
9425 
9426   auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
9427     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
9428   });
9429   if (I == FD->param_end())
9430     return true;
9431 
9432   if (Complain) {
9433     // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing
9434     unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1;
9435     if (InOverloadResolution)
9436       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
9437              diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params)
9438           << ParamNo;
9439     else
9440       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params)
9441           << FD << ParamNo;
9442   }
9443   return false;
9444 }
9445 
9446 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S,
9447                                                const FunctionDecl *FD) {
9448   return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true,
9449                                            /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9450                                            /*Loc=*/SourceLocation());
9451 }
9452 
9453 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function,
9454                                              bool Complain,
9455                                              SourceLocation Loc) {
9456   return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain,
9457                                              /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
9458                                              Loc);
9459 }
9460 
9461 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
9462 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
9463                                  QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) {
9464   if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn))
9465     return;
9466   if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion())
9467     return;
9468 
9469   std::string FnDesc;
9470   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair =
9471       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, FnDesc);
9472   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9473                          << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second
9474                          << Fn << FnDesc;
9475 
9476   HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
9477   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
9478   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found);
9479 }
9480 
9481 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
9482 // OverloadedExpr
9483 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType,
9484                                      bool TakingAddress) {
9485   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
9486 
9487   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
9488   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
9489 
9490   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9491                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9492        I != IEnd; ++I) {
9493     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
9494                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
9495       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType,
9496                             TakingAddress);
9497     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
9498                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
9499       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, DestType, TakingAddress);
9500     }
9501   }
9502 }
9503 
9504 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
9505 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
9506 /// target types of the conversion.
9507 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
9508                                  Sema &S,
9509                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
9510                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
9511   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
9512     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
9513   // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
9514   // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
9515   // refactoring here.
9516   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9517   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9518   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
9519   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9520     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
9521       break;
9522     ++CandsShown;
9523     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second);
9524   }
9525   if (I != E)
9526     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9527 }
9528 
9529 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9530                                   unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
9531   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
9532   assert(Conv.isBad());
9533   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
9534   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9535 
9536   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
9537   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
9538   // conversion-slot index.
9539   bool isObjectArgument = false;
9540   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
9541     if (I == 0)
9542       isObjectArgument = true;
9543     else
9544       I--;
9545   }
9546 
9547   std::string FnDesc;
9548   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
9549       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, FnDesc);
9550 
9551   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
9552   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
9553   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
9554 
9555   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
9556     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
9557     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
9558     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
9559       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
9560     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
9561 
9562     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
9563         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9564         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy
9565         << Name << I + 1;
9566     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9567     return;
9568   }
9569 
9570   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
9571   // to a qualifier mismatch.
9572   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
9573   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
9574   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9575     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
9576   else {
9577     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
9578     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
9579       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9580         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType();
9581         CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
9582       }
9583   }
9584 
9585   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
9586       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
9587     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
9588     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
9589 
9590     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
9591       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
9592           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9593           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9594           << FromQs.getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue()
9595           << ToQs.getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue()
9596           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
9597       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9598       return;
9599     }
9600 
9601     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
9602       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
9603           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9604           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9605           << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
9606           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
9607       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9608       return;
9609     }
9610 
9611     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
9612       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
9613           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9614           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9615           << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
9616           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
9617       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9618       return;
9619     }
9620 
9621     if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) {
9622       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned)
9623           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9624           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9625           << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1;
9626       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9627       return;
9628     }
9629 
9630     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
9631     assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
9632 
9633     if (isObjectArgument) {
9634       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
9635           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9636           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9637           << (CVR - 1);
9638     } else {
9639       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
9640           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9641           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9642           << (CVR - 1) << I + 1;
9643     }
9644     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9645     return;
9646   }
9647 
9648   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
9649   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
9650   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
9651     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
9652         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9653         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9654         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
9655     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9656     return;
9657   }
9658 
9659   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
9660   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
9661   // the failure.
9662   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
9663   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
9664     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
9665   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
9666     // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
9667     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
9668         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9669         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9670         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
9671         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
9672 
9673     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9674     return;
9675   }
9676 
9677   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
9678   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
9679   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9680     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9681       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
9682                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
9683           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
9684           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
9685           S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
9686                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
9687         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
9688     }
9689   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
9690                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
9691     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
9692                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
9693       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
9694         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
9695           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
9696                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
9697               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
9698             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
9699   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
9700     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
9701         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
9702         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
9703         S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
9704       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
9705     } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
9706                ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
9707                FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
9708       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
9709           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9710           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
9711           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
9712       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9713       return;
9714     }
9715   }
9716 
9717   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
9718     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
9719         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9720         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
9721         << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1;
9722     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9723     return;
9724   }
9725 
9726   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
9727       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
9728       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
9729       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
9730       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
9731         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
9732             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
9733             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
9734             << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
9735         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9736         return;
9737       }
9738   }
9739 
9740   if (TakingCandidateAddress &&
9741       !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function))
9742     return;
9743 
9744   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
9745   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
9746   FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
9747         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
9748         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
9749         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
9750 
9751   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
9752   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
9753        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
9754     FDiag << *HI;
9755   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
9756 
9757   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
9758 }
9759 
9760 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
9761 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
9762 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
9763 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9764                                unsigned NumArgs) {
9765   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9766   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
9767 
9768   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
9769   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
9770   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
9771   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
9772   // Just don't report anything.
9773   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
9774       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
9775     return true;
9776 
9777   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
9778     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
9779            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
9780             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
9781   } else {
9782     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
9783            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
9784             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
9785   }
9786 
9787   return false;
9788 }
9789 
9790 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
9791 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D,
9792                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
9793   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
9794       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
9795       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
9796       " or too few arguments");
9797 
9798   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
9799 
9800   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
9801   const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9802   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
9803 
9804   // at least / at most / exactly
9805   unsigned mode, modeCount;
9806   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
9807     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
9808         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
9809       mode = 0; // "at least"
9810     else
9811       mode = 2; // "exactly"
9812     modeCount = MinParams;
9813   } else {
9814     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
9815       mode = 1; // "at most"
9816     else
9817       mode = 2; // "exactly"
9818     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
9819   }
9820 
9821   std::string Description;
9822   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
9823       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, Description);
9824 
9825   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
9826     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
9827         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
9828         << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
9829   else
9830     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
9831         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
9832         << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
9833 
9834   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9835 }
9836 
9837 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
9838 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9839                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
9840   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
9841     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
9842 }
9843 
9844 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
9845   if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate())
9846     return TD;
9847   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
9848                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
9849 }
9850 
9851 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
9852 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated,
9853                                  DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
9854                                  unsigned NumArgs,
9855                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
9856   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
9857   NamedDecl *ParamD;
9858   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
9859   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
9860   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
9861   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
9862   case Sema::TDK_Success:
9863     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
9864 
9865   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
9866     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
9867     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9868            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
9869         << ParamD->getDeclName();
9870     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9871     return;
9872   }
9873 
9874   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
9875     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
9876     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
9877 
9878     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
9879 
9880     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
9881     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
9882     QualifierCollector Qs;
9883     Qs.strip(Param);
9884     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
9885     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
9886 
9887     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
9888     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
9889     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
9890     // done on dependent types).
9891     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
9892 
9893     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
9894         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
9895     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9896     return;
9897   }
9898 
9899   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
9900     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
9901     int which = 0;
9902     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
9903       which = 0;
9904     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) {
9905       // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two
9906       // different types for a non-type template parameter.
9907       // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this.
9908       QualType T1 =
9909           DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
9910       QualType T2 =
9911           DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
9912       if (!S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) {
9913         S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9914                diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types)
9915           << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1
9916           << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2;
9917         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9918         return;
9919       }
9920 
9921       which = 1;
9922     } else {
9923       which = 2;
9924     }
9925 
9926     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9927            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
9928         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
9929         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
9930     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9931     return;
9932   }
9933 
9934   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
9935     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
9936     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
9937       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9938              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
9939           << ParamD->getDeclName();
9940     else {
9941       int index = 0;
9942       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
9943         index = TTP->getIndex();
9944       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
9945                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
9946         index = NTTP->getIndex();
9947       else
9948         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
9949       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9950              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
9951           << (index + 1);
9952     }
9953     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9954     return;
9955 
9956   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9957   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
9958     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs);
9959     return;
9960 
9961   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
9962     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9963            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
9964     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
9965     return;
9966 
9967   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
9968     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
9969     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
9970     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
9971             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
9972       TemplateArgString = " ";
9973       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
9974           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
9975     }
9976 
9977     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
9978     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
9979     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
9980           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
9981       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
9982       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
9983       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
9984         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
9985       return;
9986     }
9987 
9988     // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if.
9989     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
9990         diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) {
9991       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9992              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement)
9993         << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString;
9994       return;
9995     }
9996 
9997     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
9998     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
9999     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
10000     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
10001     SourceRange R;
10002     if (PDiag) {
10003       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
10004       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
10005       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
10006     }
10007 
10008     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10009            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
10010         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
10011     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10012     return;
10013   }
10014 
10015   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
10016   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
10017     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10018     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10019     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10020             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10021       TemplateArgString = " ";
10022       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10023           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10024     }
10025 
10026     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch)
10027         << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1)
10028         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()
10029         << TemplateArgString
10030         << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested);
10031     break;
10032   }
10033 
10034   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
10035     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
10036     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10037     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10038     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
10039         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
10040       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
10041       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
10042       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
10043           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
10044         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
10045             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
10046           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
10047           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
10048           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
10049           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
10050           //    name for types, not decls.
10051           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
10052           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10053                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
10054               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
10055           return;
10056         }
10057       }
10058     }
10059 
10060     if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) &&
10061         !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated)))
10062       return;
10063 
10064     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
10065     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
10066     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
10067     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
10068     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10069            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
10070         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
10071     return;
10072   }
10073   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
10074   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
10075   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
10076     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
10077     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10078     return;
10079   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
10080     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10081            diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch);
10082     return;
10083   }
10084 }
10085 
10086 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
10087 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10088                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10089                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10090   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
10091   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
10092     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
10093       return;
10094   }
10095   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern
10096                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress);
10097 }
10098 
10099 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
10100 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10101   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
10102   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
10103 
10104   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
10105                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
10106 
10107   std::string FnDesc;
10108   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10109       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, FnDesc);
10110 
10111   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
10112       << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
10113       << FnDesc /* Ignored */
10114       << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
10115 
10116   // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the
10117   // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case.
10118   CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee);
10119   if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) {
10120     CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent();
10121     Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM;
10122 
10123     switch (FnKindPair.first) {
10124     default:
10125       return;
10126     case oc_implicit_default_constructor:
10127       CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor;
10128       break;
10129     case oc_implicit_copy_constructor:
10130       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor;
10131       break;
10132     case oc_implicit_move_constructor:
10133       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor;
10134       break;
10135     case oc_implicit_copy_assignment:
10136       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment;
10137       break;
10138     case oc_implicit_move_assignment:
10139       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment;
10140       break;
10141     };
10142 
10143     bool ConstRHS = false;
10144     if (Meth->getNumParams()) {
10145       if (const ReferenceType *RT =
10146               Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
10147         ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified();
10148       }
10149     }
10150 
10151     S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth,
10152                                               /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS,
10153                                               /* Diagnose */ true);
10154   }
10155 }
10156 
10157 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10158   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
10159   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
10160 
10161   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
10162          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
10163       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
10164 }
10165 
10166 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10167   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
10168 
10169   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
10170          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension);
10171 }
10172 
10173 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
10174 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
10175 ///
10176 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
10177 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
10178 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
10179 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
10180 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
10181 /// overload.
10182 ///
10183 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
10184 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
10185 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
10186 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10187                                   unsigned NumArgs,
10188                                   bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10189   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10190 
10191   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
10192   if (Cand->Viable) {
10193     if (Fn->isDeleted() || S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn)) {
10194       std::string FnDesc;
10195       std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10196           ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, FnDesc);
10197 
10198       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
10199           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10200           << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
10201       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10202       return;
10203     }
10204 
10205     // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
10206     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn);
10207     return;
10208   }
10209 
10210   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
10211   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
10212   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
10213     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
10214 
10215   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
10216     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs,
10217                                 TakingCandidateAddress);
10218 
10219   case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: {
10220     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor)
10221       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0);
10222     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10223     return;
10224   }
10225 
10226   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
10227   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
10228   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
10229     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn);
10230 
10231   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
10232     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
10233     for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
10234       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
10235         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress);
10236 
10237     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
10238     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
10239     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
10240     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn);
10241   }
10242 
10243   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
10244     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
10245 
10246   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
10247     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
10248 
10249   case ovl_fail_ext_disabled:
10250     return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand);
10251 
10252   case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice:
10253     // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here.
10254     if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor())
10255       return;
10256     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
10257            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice)
10258       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0)
10259       << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType();
10260     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10261     return;
10262 
10263   case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: {
10264     bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function);
10265     (void)Available;
10266     assert(!Available);
10267     break;
10268   }
10269   case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function:
10270     // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored.
10271     break;
10272   }
10273 }
10274 
10275 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10276   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
10277   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
10278   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
10279   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
10280   bool isLValueReference = false;
10281   bool isRValueReference = false;
10282   bool isPointer = false;
10283   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
10284         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
10285     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
10286     isLValueReference = true;
10287   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
10288                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
10289     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
10290     isRValueReference = true;
10291   }
10292   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10293     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
10294     isPointer = true;
10295   }
10296   // Desugar down to a function type.
10297   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
10298   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
10299   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
10300   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
10301   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
10302 
10303   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
10304     << FnType;
10305 }
10306 
10307 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc,
10308                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
10309                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10310   assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
10311   std::string TypeStr("operator");
10312   TypeStr += Opc;
10313   TypeStr += "(";
10314   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString();
10315   if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
10316     TypeStr += ")";
10317     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
10318   } else {
10319     TypeStr += ", ";
10320     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString();
10321     TypeStr += ")";
10322     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
10323   }
10324 }
10325 
10326 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10327                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10328   for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) {
10329     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
10330     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
10331 
10332     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
10333         S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
10334   }
10335 }
10336 
10337 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10338   if (Cand->Function)
10339     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
10340   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
10341     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
10342   return SourceLocation();
10343 }
10344 
10345 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
10346   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
10347   case Sema::TDK_Success:
10348   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
10349     llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction");
10350 
10351   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
10352   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
10353     return 1;
10354 
10355   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
10356   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
10357     return 2;
10358 
10359   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
10360   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
10361   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
10362   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
10363   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
10364   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
10365     return 3;
10366 
10367   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
10368     return 4;
10369 
10370   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
10371     return 5;
10372 
10373   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
10374   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
10375     return 6;
10376   }
10377   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
10378 }
10379 
10380 namespace {
10381 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
10382   Sema &S;
10383   SourceLocation Loc;
10384   size_t NumArgs;
10385   OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK;
10386 
10387   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(
10388       Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs,
10389       OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK)
10390       : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {}
10391 
10392   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
10393                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
10394     // Fast-path this check.
10395     if (L == R) return false;
10396 
10397     // Order first by viability.
10398     if (L->Viable) {
10399       if (!R->Viable) return true;
10400 
10401       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
10402       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
10403       // that could exploit it.
10404       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK))
10405         return true;
10406       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK))
10407         return false;
10408     } else if (R->Viable)
10409       return false;
10410 
10411     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
10412 
10413     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
10414     if (!L->Viable) {
10415       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
10416       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
10417           L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
10418         if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
10419             R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
10420           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
10421           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
10422           if (LDist == RDist) {
10423             if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind)
10424               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
10425               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
10426             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
10427             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
10428             // than there were arguments given.
10429             return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
10430           }
10431           return LDist < RDist;
10432         }
10433         return false;
10434       }
10435       if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
10436           R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
10437         return true;
10438 
10439       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
10440       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
10441       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
10442         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
10443           return true;
10444 
10445         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
10446         // comes first.
10447         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
10448         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
10449         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
10450         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
10451         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
10452           return numLFixes < numRFixes;
10453         }
10454 
10455         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
10456         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
10457         assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
10458 
10459         int leftBetter = 0;
10460         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
10461         for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
10462           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
10463                                                      L->Conversions[I],
10464                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
10465           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
10466             leftBetter++;
10467             break;
10468 
10469           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
10470             leftBetter--;
10471             break;
10472 
10473           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
10474             break;
10475           }
10476         }
10477         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
10478         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
10479 
10480       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
10481         return false;
10482 
10483       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
10484         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
10485           return true;
10486 
10487         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
10488           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
10489                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
10490       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
10491         return false;
10492 
10493       // TODO: others?
10494     }
10495 
10496     // Sort everything else by location.
10497     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
10498     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
10499 
10500     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
10501     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
10502     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
10503 
10504     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
10505   }
10506 };
10507 }
10508 
10509 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
10510 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if
10511 /// possible.
10512 static void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10513                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
10514   assert(!Cand->Viable);
10515 
10516   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
10517   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
10518 
10519   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
10520   bool Unfixable = false;
10521   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
10522   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
10523 
10524   // Attempt to fix the bad conversion.
10525   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
10526   for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/;
10527        ++ConvIdx) {
10528     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
10529     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
10530         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
10531       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
10532       break;
10533     }
10534   }
10535 
10536   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
10537   // operation somehow.
10538   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
10539 
10540   unsigned ConvIdx = 0;
10541   ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes;
10542 
10543   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
10544     QualType ConvType
10545       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10546     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10547       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
10548     ParamTypes = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
10549     // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding argument.
10550     ConvIdx = 1;
10551   } else if (Cand->Function) {
10552     ParamTypes =
10553         Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
10554     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
10555         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) {
10556       // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding argument.
10557       ConvIdx = 1;
10558     }
10559   } else {
10560     // Builtin operator.
10561     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
10562     ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes;
10563   }
10564 
10565   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
10566   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
10567     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
10568       // We've already checked this conversion.
10569     } else if (ArgIdx < ParamTypes.size()) {
10570       if (ParamTypes[ArgIdx]->isDependentType())
10571         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion(
10572             Args[ArgIdx]->getType());
10573       else {
10574         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] =
10575             TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ArgIdx],
10576                                   SuppressUserConversions,
10577                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
10578                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
10579                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
10580         // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
10581         if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
10582           Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
10583       }
10584     } else
10585       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
10586   }
10587 }
10588 
10589 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the
10590 /// candidates in the candidate set.
10591 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(
10592     Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10593     StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10594     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
10595   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
10596   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
10597   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
10598   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
10599   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
10600     if (!Filter(*Cand))
10601       continue;
10602     if (Cand->Viable)
10603       Cands.push_back(Cand);
10604     else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
10605       CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
10606       if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
10607         Cands.push_back(Cand);
10608       // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
10609       // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
10610     }
10611   }
10612 
10613   std::stable_sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
10614             CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind));
10615 
10616   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
10617 
10618   SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
10619   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
10620   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
10621   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10622     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
10623 
10624     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
10625     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
10626     // candidate list.
10627     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
10628       break;
10629     }
10630     ++CandsShown;
10631 
10632     if (Cand->Function)
10633       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(),
10634                             /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false);
10635     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
10636       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
10637     else {
10638       assert(Cand->Viable &&
10639              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
10640       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
10641       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
10642       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
10643       //
10644       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
10645       // different ambiguities, though.
10646       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
10647         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
10648         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
10649       }
10650 
10651       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
10652       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
10653     }
10654   }
10655 
10656   if (I != E)
10657     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
10658 }
10659 
10660 static SourceLocation
10661 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
10662   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
10663                               : SourceLocation();
10664 }
10665 
10666 namespace {
10667 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
10668   Sema &S;
10669   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
10670 
10671   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
10672                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
10673     // Fast-path this check.
10674     if (L == R)
10675       return false;
10676 
10677     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
10678 
10679     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
10680     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
10681       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
10682              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
10683 
10684     // Sort everything else by location.
10685     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
10686     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
10687 
10688     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
10689     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
10690       return false;
10691     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
10692       return true;
10693 
10694     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
10695   }
10696 };
10697 }
10698 
10699 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
10700 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
10701 /// deductions.
10702 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S,
10703                                                  bool ForTakingAddress) {
10704   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern
10705                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress);
10706 }
10707 
10708 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
10709   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
10710     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
10711   }
10712 }
10713 
10714 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
10715   destroyCandidates();
10716   Candidates.clear();
10717 }
10718 
10719 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
10720 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
10721 /// the candidate set.
10722 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
10723 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
10724 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
10725   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
10726   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
10727   // and sort those.
10728   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
10729   Cands.reserve(size());
10730   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
10731     if (Cand->Specialization)
10732       Cands.push_back(Cand);
10733     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
10734     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
10735   }
10736 
10737   llvm::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
10738              CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
10739 
10740   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
10741   // for generalization purposes (?).
10742   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
10743 
10744   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
10745   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
10746   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10747     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
10748 
10749     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
10750     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
10751     // candidate list.
10752     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
10753       break;
10754     ++CandsShown;
10755 
10756     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
10757            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
10758     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress);
10759   }
10760 
10761   if (I != E)
10762     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
10763 }
10764 
10765 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
10766 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
10767 // R (A) --> R(A)
10768 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
10769 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
10770 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
10771 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
10772   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
10773   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
10774     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
10775     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
10776   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
10777     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
10778     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
10779   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
10780     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
10781     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
10782   Ret =
10783     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
10784   return Ret;
10785 }
10786 
10787 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc,
10788                                  bool Complain = true) {
10789   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
10790       S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain))
10791     return true;
10792 
10793   auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10794   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
10795       isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) &&
10796       !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT))
10797     return true;
10798 
10799   return false;
10800 }
10801 
10802 namespace {
10803 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
10804 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
10805 class AddressOfFunctionResolver {
10806   Sema& S;
10807   Expr* SourceExpr;
10808   const QualType& TargetType;
10809   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
10810 
10811   bool Complain;
10812   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
10813   ASTContext& Context;
10814 
10815   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
10816   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
10817   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
10818   bool HasComplained;
10819 
10820   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
10821   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
10822   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
10823   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
10824   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
10825 
10826 public:
10827   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
10828                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
10829       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
10830         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
10831         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
10832             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
10833         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
10834         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
10835         HasComplained(false),
10836         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
10837         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
10838         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) {
10839     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
10840 
10841     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
10842       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
10843         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
10844             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
10845           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
10846     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10847       DeclAccessPair dap;
10848       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10849               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
10850         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
10851           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10852             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
10853             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
10854             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
10855             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
10856 
10857             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
10858             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
10859             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
10860               return;
10861           }
10862 
10863         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
10864       }
10865       return;
10866     }
10867 
10868     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
10869       OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
10870 
10871     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
10872       // C++ [over.over]p4:
10873       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
10874       if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) {
10875         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
10876           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
10877         else
10878           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
10879       }
10880     }
10881 
10882     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1)
10883       EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches();
10884   }
10885 
10886   bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; }
10887 
10888 private:
10889   bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10890     QualType Discard;
10891     return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) ||
10892            S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard);
10893   }
10894 
10895   /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the
10896   /// desired type than B.
10897   bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) {
10898     // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it
10899     // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to
10900     // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match.
10901     return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) &&
10902            (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) ||
10903             compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better);
10904   }
10905 
10906   /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate,
10907   /// false otherwise.
10908   bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() {
10909     // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best",
10910     // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best.
10911     auto Best = Matches.begin();
10912     for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I)
10913       if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second))
10914         Best = I;
10915 
10916     const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second;
10917     auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn](
10918         const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) {
10919       return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second);
10920     };
10921 
10922     // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best
10923     // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error
10924     if (!std::all_of(Matches.begin(), Matches.end(), IsBestOrInferiorToBest))
10925       return false;
10926     Matches[0] = *Best;
10927     Matches.resize(1);
10928     return true;
10929   }
10930 
10931   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
10932     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
10933   }
10934 
10935   // [ToType]     [Return]
10936 
10937   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
10938   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
10939   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
10940   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
10941     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
10942   }
10943 
10944   // return true if any matching specializations were found
10945   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
10946                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
10947     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
10948               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
10949       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
10950       // static when converting to member pointer.
10951       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10952         return false;
10953     }
10954     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10955       return false;
10956 
10957     // C++ [over.over]p2:
10958     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
10959     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
10960     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
10961     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
10962     //   overloaded functions considered.
10963     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
10964     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
10965     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
10966           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
10967                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
10968                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
10969                                       Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
10970       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
10971       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
10972           .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
10973                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
10974       return false;
10975     }
10976 
10977     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
10978     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
10979     // This function template specicalization works.
10980     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
10981               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
10982               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
10983 
10984     if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization))
10985       return false;
10986 
10987     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
10988     return true;
10989   }
10990 
10991   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
10992                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
10993     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10994       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
10995       // when converting to member pointer.
10996       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10997         return false;
10998     }
10999     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
11000       return false;
11001 
11002     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
11003       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
11004         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
11005           if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl))
11006             return false;
11007       if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) {
11008         const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
11009         assert(TA && "Multiversioned functions require a target attribute");
11010         if (!TA->isDefaultVersion())
11011           return false;
11012       }
11013 
11014       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
11015       // now.
11016       if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
11017                                Complain)) {
11018         HasComplained |= Complain;
11019         return false;
11020       }
11021 
11022       if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl))
11023         return false;
11024 
11025       // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical.
11026       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
11027           candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) {
11028         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(
11029             CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
11030         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
11031         return true;
11032       }
11033     }
11034 
11035     return false;
11036   }
11037 
11038   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
11039     bool Ret = false;
11040 
11041     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
11042     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
11043     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
11044       return false;
11045 
11046     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
11047                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
11048          I != E; ++I) {
11049       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
11050       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
11051 
11052       // C++ [over.over]p3:
11053       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
11054       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
11055       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
11056       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
11057       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
11058       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
11059                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
11060         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
11061           Ret = true;
11062       }
11063       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
11064       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
11065                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
11066         Ret = true;
11067     }
11068     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
11069     return Ret;
11070   }
11071 
11072   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
11073     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
11074     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
11075     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
11076     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
11077     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
11078 
11079     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
11080     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
11081     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
11082     // best function template (if it exists).
11083 
11084     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
11085     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
11086       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
11087 
11088     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
11089     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
11090     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
11091         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
11092         SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(),
11093         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
11094             << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
11095         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
11096             << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template,
11097         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
11098 
11099     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
11100       // Make it the first and only element
11101       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
11102       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
11103       Matches.resize(1);
11104     } else
11105       HasComplained |= Complain;
11106   }
11107 
11108   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
11109     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
11110     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
11111     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
11112       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
11113         ++I;
11114       else {
11115         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
11116         Matches.resize(N);
11117       }
11118     }
11119   }
11120 
11121   void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() {
11122     S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches);
11123   }
11124 
11125 public:
11126   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
11127     assert(Matches.empty());
11128     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
11129         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
11130         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
11131     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
11132       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
11133                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
11134     else {
11135       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
11136       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
11137       // normally.
11138       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
11139                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
11140            I != IEnd; ++I)
11141         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
11142                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
11143           if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun))
11144             S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, TargetFunctionType,
11145                                     /*TakingAddress=*/true);
11146       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart());
11147     }
11148   }
11149 
11150   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
11151     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
11152       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
11153   }
11154 
11155   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
11156       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
11157       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
11158       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
11159       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
11160         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
11161   }
11162 
11163   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
11164     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
11165   }
11166 
11167   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
11168     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(),
11169            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
11170       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
11171   }
11172 
11173   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
11174     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
11175       << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
11176   }
11177 
11178   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
11179     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
11180     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
11181       << OvlExpr->getName()
11182       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
11183     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
11184                                 /*TakingAddress=*/true);
11185   }
11186 
11187   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
11188 
11189   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
11190 
11191   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
11192     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
11193     return Matches[0].second;
11194   }
11195 
11196   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
11197     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
11198     return &Matches[0].first;
11199   }
11200 };
11201 }
11202 
11203 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
11204 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
11205 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
11206 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
11207 ///
11208 /// @code
11209 /// int f(double);
11210 /// int f(int);
11211 ///
11212 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
11213 /// @endcode
11214 ///
11215 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
11216 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
11217 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
11218 FunctionDecl *
11219 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
11220                                          QualType TargetType,
11221                                          bool Complain,
11222                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
11223                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
11224   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11225 
11226   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
11227                                      Complain);
11228   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
11229   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
11230   bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained();
11231   if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) {
11232     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
11233       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
11234     else
11235       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
11236   }
11237   else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain)
11238     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
11239   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
11240     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
11241     assert(Fn);
11242     if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11243       ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT);
11244     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
11245     if (Complain) {
11246       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
11247         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
11248       else
11249         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
11250     }
11251   }
11252 
11253   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
11254     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
11255   return Fn;
11256 }
11257 
11258 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
11259 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken.
11260 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null.
11261 ///
11262 /// This routine can only realistically succeed if all but one candidates in the
11263 /// overload set for SrcExpr cannot have their addresses taken.
11264 FunctionDecl *
11265 Sema::resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(Expr *E,
11266                                                   DeclAccessPair &Pair) {
11267   OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E);
11268   OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression;
11269   FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr;
11270   DeclAccessPair DAP;
11271   // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for
11272   // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks
11273   // enable_if/pass_object_size/...
11274   for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11275     auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl());
11276     if (!FD)
11277       return nullptr;
11278 
11279     if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
11280       continue;
11281 
11282     // We have more than one result; quit.
11283     if (Result)
11284       return nullptr;
11285     DAP = I.getPair();
11286     Result = FD;
11287   }
11288 
11289   if (Result)
11290     Pair = DAP;
11291   return Result;
11292 }
11293 
11294 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded
11295 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate. This
11296 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if
11297 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay.
11298 ///
11299 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate fails.
11300 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true.
11301 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(
11302     ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) {
11303   Expr *E = SrcExpr.get();
11304   assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload");
11305 
11306   DeclAccessPair DAP;
11307   FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(E, DAP);
11308   if (!Found)
11309     return false;
11310 
11311   // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and
11312   // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check
11313   // for both.
11314   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc());
11315   CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP);
11316   Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found);
11317   if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType())
11318     SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false);
11319   else
11320     SrcExpr = Fixed;
11321   return true;
11322 }
11323 
11324 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
11325 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
11326 ///
11327 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
11328 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
11329 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
11330 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
11331 ///
11332 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
11333 /// returned.
11334 FunctionDecl *
11335 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
11336                                                   bool Complain,
11337                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
11338   // C++ [over.over]p1:
11339   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
11340   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
11341   // C++ [over.over]p1:
11342   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
11343   //   operator.
11344 
11345   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
11346   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
11347     return nullptr;
11348 
11349   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
11350   ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
11351   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
11352 
11353   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
11354   // whose type matches exactly.
11355   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
11356   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
11357          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11358     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
11359     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
11360     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
11361     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
11362     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
11363     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
11364     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
11365       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
11366 
11367     // C++ [over.over]p2:
11368     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
11369     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
11370     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
11371     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
11372     //   overloaded functions considered.
11373     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
11374     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
11375     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
11376           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
11377                                     Specialization, Info,
11378                                     /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
11379       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
11380       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
11381       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
11382           .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
11383                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
11384       continue;
11385     }
11386 
11387     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
11388 
11389     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
11390     if (Matched) {
11391       if (Complain) {
11392         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
11393           << ovl->getName();
11394         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
11395       }
11396       return nullptr;
11397     }
11398 
11399     Matched = Specialization;
11400     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
11401   }
11402 
11403   if (Matched &&
11404       completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
11405     return nullptr;
11406 
11407   return Matched;
11408 }
11409 
11410 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
11411 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
11412 //
11413 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
11414 //
11415 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
11416 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
11417 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
11418 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
11419                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
11420                       bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining,
11421                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
11422                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
11423   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11424 
11425   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
11426 
11427   DeclAccessPair found;
11428   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
11429   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
11430                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
11431     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
11432       SrcExpr = ExprError();
11433       return true;
11434     }
11435 
11436     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
11437     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
11438     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
11439     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
11440     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
11441         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
11442         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
11443       if (!complain) return false;
11444 
11445       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
11446            diag::err_bound_member_function)
11447         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
11448 
11449       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
11450       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
11451       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
11452       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
11453       // the static candidates were rejected.
11454       SrcExpr = ExprError();
11455       return true;
11456     }
11457 
11458     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
11459     SingleFunctionExpression =
11460         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
11461 
11462     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
11463     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
11464       SingleFunctionExpression =
11465         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
11466       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
11467         SrcExpr = ExprError();
11468         return true;
11469       }
11470     }
11471   }
11472 
11473   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
11474     if (complain) {
11475       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
11476         << ovl.Expression->getName()
11477         << DestTypeForComplaining
11478         << OpRangeForComplaining
11479         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
11480       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
11481 
11482       SrcExpr = ExprError();
11483       return true;
11484     }
11485 
11486     return false;
11487   }
11488 
11489   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
11490   return true;
11491 }
11492 
11493 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set.
11494 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
11495                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
11496                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
11497                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11498                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
11499                                        bool PartialOverloading,
11500                                        bool KnownValid) {
11501   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
11502   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
11503     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
11504 
11505   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
11506     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
11507       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
11508       return;
11509     }
11510     // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates.
11511     if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()))
11512       return;
11513 
11514     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
11515                            /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false,
11516                            PartialOverloading);
11517     return;
11518   }
11519 
11520   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
11521       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
11522     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
11523                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
11524                                    /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false,
11525                                    PartialOverloading);
11526     return;
11527   }
11528 
11529   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
11530 }
11531 
11532 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
11533 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
11534 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
11535                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11536                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
11537                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
11538 
11539 #ifndef NDEBUG
11540   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
11541   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
11542   //
11543   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
11544   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
11545   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
11546   //
11547   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
11548   //
11549   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
11550   //        using-declaration, or
11551   //
11552   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
11553   //        template
11554   //
11555   //   then Y is empty.
11556 
11557   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
11558     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
11559            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11560       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
11561       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
11562              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
11563       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
11564     }
11565   }
11566 #endif
11567 
11568   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
11569   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
11570   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
11571   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11572     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
11573     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
11574   }
11575 
11576   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
11577          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
11578     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
11579                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
11580                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
11581 
11582   if (ULE->requiresADL())
11583     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
11584                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
11585                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
11586 }
11587 
11588 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
11589 /// a different namespace.
11590 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
11591   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
11592   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
11593   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
11594     return false;
11595 
11596   default:
11597     return true;
11598   }
11599 }
11600 
11601 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
11602 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
11603 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
11604 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
11605 ///
11606 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
11607 static bool
11608 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
11609                        const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
11610                        OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
11611                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
11612                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11613                        bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) {
11614   if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty())
11615     return false;
11616 
11617   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
11618     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
11619       continue;
11620 
11621     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
11622 
11623     if (!R.empty()) {
11624       R.suppressDiagnostics();
11625 
11626       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
11627         // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
11628         // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
11629         R.clear();
11630         if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)
11631           *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true;
11632         return false;
11633       }
11634 
11635       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
11636       for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
11637         AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
11638                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
11639                                    Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
11640 
11641       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11642       if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
11643         // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
11644         // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
11645         R.clear();
11646         return false;
11647       }
11648 
11649       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
11650       // declaring the function there instead.
11651       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
11652       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
11653       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
11654                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
11655                                                  AssociatedClasses);
11656       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
11657       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
11658         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
11659         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
11660                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
11661                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
11662           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
11663           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
11664             continue;
11665 
11666           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
11667           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
11668           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
11669           if (NS &&
11670               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
11671             continue;
11672 
11673           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
11674         }
11675       }
11676 
11677       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
11678         << R.getLookupName();
11679       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
11680         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
11681                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
11682           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
11683       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
11684         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
11685                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
11686           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
11687       } else {
11688         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
11689         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
11690         // a localized representation of a list of items.
11691         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
11692                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
11693           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
11694       }
11695 
11696       // Try to recover by calling this function.
11697       return true;
11698     }
11699 
11700     R.clear();
11701   }
11702 
11703   return false;
11704 }
11705 
11706 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
11707 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
11708 /// was defined.
11709 ///
11710 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
11711 static bool
11712 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
11713                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
11714                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
11715   DeclarationName OpName =
11716     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
11717   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
11718   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
11719                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
11720                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
11721 }
11722 
11723 namespace {
11724 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
11725   Sema &SemaRef;
11726 public:
11727   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
11728     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
11729     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
11730   }
11731 
11732   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
11733     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
11734   }
11735 };
11736 
11737 }
11738 
11739 static std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback>
11740 MakeValidator(Sema &SemaRef, MemberExpr *ME, size_t NumArgs,
11741               bool HasTemplateArgs, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
11742   if (!AllowTypoCorrection)
11743     return llvm::make_unique<NoTypoCorrectionCCC>();
11744   return llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallFilterCCC>(SemaRef, NumArgs,
11745                                                   HasTemplateArgs, ME);
11746 }
11747 
11748 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
11749 ///
11750 /// Returns true if new candidates were found.
11751 static ExprResult
11752 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
11753                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
11754                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11755                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11756                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11757                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
11758   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
11759   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
11760   //
11761   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
11762   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
11763   //
11764   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
11765     return ExprError();
11766   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
11767 
11768   CXXScopeSpec SS;
11769   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
11770   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
11771 
11772   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
11773   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
11774   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11775     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
11776     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
11777   }
11778 
11779   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
11780                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
11781   bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup;
11782   if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
11783                               OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
11784                               ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
11785                               &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) &&
11786     (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(
11787         S, SS, R,
11788         MakeValidator(SemaRef, dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn), Args.size(),
11789                       ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, AllowTypoCorrection),
11790         ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
11791     return ExprError();
11792 
11793   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
11794 
11795   // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out.
11796   if (R.isAmbiguous()) {
11797     R.suppressDiagnostics();
11798     return ExprError();
11799   }
11800 
11801   // Build an implicit member call if appropriate.  Just drop the
11802   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
11803   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
11804   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
11805     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R,
11806                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs, S);
11807   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
11808     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
11809                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
11810   else
11811     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
11812 
11813   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11814     return ExprError();
11815 
11816   // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
11817   // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
11818   // end up here.
11819   return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
11820                                MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
11821                                RParenLoc);
11822 }
11823 
11824 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
11825 /// the given function.
11826 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
11827 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
11828                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
11829                                   MultiExprArg Args,
11830                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11831                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11832                                   ExprResult *Result) {
11833 #ifndef NDEBUG
11834   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
11835     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
11836     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
11837 
11838     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
11839     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
11840     FunctionDecl *F;
11841     if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
11842         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
11843         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
11844       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
11845 
11846     // We don't perform ADL in C.
11847     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
11848   }
11849 #endif
11850 
11851   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
11852   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
11853     *Result = ExprError();
11854     return true;
11855   }
11856 
11857   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
11858   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
11859   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
11860 
11861   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
11862       CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() &&
11863       (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
11864 
11865     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11866     if (CandidateSet->empty() ||
11867         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best) ==
11868             OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11869       // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
11870       // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
11871       // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
11872       // classes.
11873       CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(
11874           Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
11875       CE->setTypeDependent(true);
11876       CE->setValueDependent(true);
11877       CE->setInstantiationDependent(true);
11878       *Result = CE;
11879       return true;
11880     }
11881   }
11882 
11883   if (CandidateSet->empty())
11884     return false;
11885 
11886   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11887   return false;
11888 }
11889 
11890 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
11891 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
11892 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
11893 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
11894                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
11895                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11896                                            MultiExprArg Args,
11897                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11898                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
11899                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11900                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
11901                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
11902                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
11903   if (CandidateSet->empty())
11904     return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
11905                                  RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
11906                                  AllowTypoCorrection);
11907 
11908   switch (OverloadResult) {
11909   case OR_Success: {
11910     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
11911     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
11912     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
11913       return ExprError();
11914     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
11915     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
11916                                          ExecConfig);
11917   }
11918 
11919   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11920     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
11921     // have meant to call.
11922     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
11923                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
11924                                                 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
11925                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
11926     if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
11927       return Recovery;
11928 
11929     // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we
11930     // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to
11931     // emit better ones.
11932     for (const Expr *Arg : Args) {
11933       if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType())
11934         continue;
11935       if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
11936         auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
11937         if (FD &&
11938             !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
11939                                                        Arg->getExprLoc()))
11940           return ExprError();
11941       }
11942     }
11943 
11944     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11945         << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
11946     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11947     break;
11948   }
11949 
11950   case OR_Ambiguous:
11951     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
11952       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
11953     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11954     break;
11955 
11956   case OR_Deleted: {
11957     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
11958       << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
11959       << ULE->getName()
11960       << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
11961       << Fn->getSourceRange();
11962     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11963 
11964     // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep
11965     // the call in the AST.
11966     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
11967     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
11968     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
11969                                          ExecConfig);
11970   }
11971   }
11972 
11973   // Overload resolution failed.
11974   return ExprError();
11975 }
11976 
11977 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S,
11978                                                 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) {
11979   for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) {
11980     if (I->Viable &&
11981         !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) {
11982       I->Viable = false;
11983       I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available;
11984     }
11985   }
11986 }
11987 
11988 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
11989 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
11990 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
11991 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
11992 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
11993 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
11994 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
11995                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
11996                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11997                                          MultiExprArg Args,
11998                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11999                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
12000                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection,
12001                                          bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) {
12002   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
12003                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
12004   ExprResult result;
12005 
12006   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
12007                              &result))
12008     return result;
12009 
12010   // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that
12011   // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable.
12012   if (CalleesAddressIsTaken)
12013     markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet);
12014 
12015   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12016   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
12017       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
12018 
12019   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
12020                                   RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
12021                                   &Best, OverloadResult,
12022                                   AllowTypoCorrection);
12023 }
12024 
12025 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
12026   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
12027     (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
12028 }
12029 
12030 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
12031 /// operator.
12032 ///
12033 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
12034 ///
12035 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
12036 ///
12037 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
12038 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
12039 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
12040 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
12041 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
12042 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
12043 ///
12044 /// \param Input The input argument.
12045 ExprResult
12046 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
12047                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
12048                               Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) {
12049   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
12050   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
12051   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
12052   // TODO: provide better source location info.
12053   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
12054 
12055   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
12056     return ExprError();
12057 
12058   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
12059   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
12060 
12061   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
12062   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
12063   // post-decrement.
12064   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
12065     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
12066     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
12067                                      SourceLocation());
12068     NumArgs = 2;
12069   }
12070 
12071   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
12072 
12073   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
12074     if (Fns.empty())
12075       return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
12076                                          VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false);
12077 
12078     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
12079     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
12080       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
12081                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
12082                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
12083                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
12084     return new (Context)
12085         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy,
12086                             VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPOptions());
12087   }
12088 
12089   // Build an empty overload set.
12090   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
12091 
12092   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
12093   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
12094 
12095   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
12096   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
12097 
12098   // Add candidates from ADL.
12099   if (PerformADL) {
12100     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
12101                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
12102                                          CandidateSet);
12103   }
12104 
12105   // Add builtin operator candidates.
12106   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
12107 
12108   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12109 
12110   // Perform overload resolution.
12111   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12112   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
12113   case OR_Success: {
12114     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
12115     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
12116 
12117     if (FnDecl) {
12118       Expr *Base = nullptr;
12119       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
12120       // operator.
12121 
12122       // Convert the arguments.
12123       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
12124         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
12125 
12126         ExprResult InputRes =
12127           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
12128                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12129         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
12130           return ExprError();
12131         Base = Input = InputRes.get();
12132       } else {
12133         // Convert the arguments.
12134         ExprResult InputInit
12135           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
12136                                                       Context,
12137                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
12138                                       SourceLocation(),
12139                                       Input);
12140         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
12141           return ExprError();
12142         Input = InputInit.get();
12143       }
12144 
12145       // Build the actual expression node.
12146       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
12147                                                 Base, HadMultipleCandidates,
12148                                                 OpLoc);
12149       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
12150         return ExprError();
12151 
12152       // Determine the result type.
12153       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
12154       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12155       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12156 
12157       Args[0] = Input;
12158       CallExpr *TheCall =
12159         new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray,
12160                                           ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions());
12161 
12162       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
12163         return ExprError();
12164 
12165       if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall,
12166                             FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
12167         return ExprError();
12168 
12169       return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12170     } else {
12171       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
12172       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
12173       // operator node.
12174       ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion(
12175           Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
12176       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
12177         return ExprError();
12178       Input = InputRes.get();
12179       break;
12180     }
12181   }
12182 
12183   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12184     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
12185     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
12186     // defined too late to be candidates.
12187     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
12188       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
12189       return ExprError();
12190 
12191     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
12192     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
12193     break;
12194 
12195   case OR_Ambiguous:
12196     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
12197         << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
12198         << Input->getType()
12199         << Input->getSourceRange();
12200     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
12201                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
12202     return ExprError();
12203 
12204   case OR_Deleted:
12205     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
12206       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
12207       << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
12208       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
12209       << Input->getSourceRange();
12210     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
12211                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
12212     return ExprError();
12213   }
12214 
12215   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
12216   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
12217   // build a built-in operation.
12218   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
12219 }
12220 
12221 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
12222 /// operator.
12223 ///
12224 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
12225 ///
12226 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
12227 ///
12228 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
12229 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
12230 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
12231 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
12232 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
12233 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
12234 ///
12235 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
12236 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
12237 ExprResult
12238 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
12239                             BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
12240                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
12241                             Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL) {
12242   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
12243   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
12244 
12245   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
12246   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
12247 
12248   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
12249   // expression.
12250   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
12251     if (Fns.empty()) {
12252       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
12253       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
12254       if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
12255         return new (Context) BinaryOperator(
12256             Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12257             OpLoc, FPFeatures);
12258 
12259       return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
12260           Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
12261           Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc,
12262           FPFeatures);
12263     }
12264 
12265     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
12266     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
12267     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
12268     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
12269     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
12270       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
12271                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
12272                                      /*ADL*/PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns),
12273                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
12274     return new (Context)
12275         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy,
12276                             VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures);
12277   }
12278 
12279   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
12280   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
12281     return ExprError();
12282 
12283   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
12284   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
12285   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
12286   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
12287     return ExprError();
12288 
12289   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
12290   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
12291   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
12292   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
12293   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
12294   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
12295   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
12296     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
12297 
12298   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
12299   // create a built-in binary operator.
12300   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
12301     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
12302 
12303   // Build an empty overload set.
12304   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
12305 
12306   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
12307   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet);
12308 
12309   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
12310   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
12311 
12312   // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not
12313   // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->,
12314   // which don't get here).
12315   if (Opc != BO_Assign && PerformADL)
12316     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
12317                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
12318                                          CandidateSet);
12319 
12320   // Add builtin operator candidates.
12321   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
12322 
12323   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12324 
12325   // Perform overload resolution.
12326   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12327   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
12328     case OR_Success: {
12329       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
12330       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
12331 
12332       if (FnDecl) {
12333         Expr *Base = nullptr;
12334         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
12335         // operator.
12336 
12337         // Convert the arguments.
12338         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
12339           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
12340           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
12341 
12342           ExprResult Arg1 =
12343             PerformCopyInitialization(
12344               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
12345                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
12346               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
12347           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
12348             return ExprError();
12349 
12350           ExprResult Arg0 =
12351             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
12352                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12353           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
12354             return ExprError();
12355           Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
12356           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
12357         } else {
12358           // Convert the arguments.
12359           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
12360             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
12361                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
12362             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
12363           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
12364             return ExprError();
12365 
12366           ExprResult Arg1 =
12367             PerformCopyInitialization(
12368               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
12369                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
12370               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
12371           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
12372             return ExprError();
12373           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
12374           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
12375         }
12376 
12377         // Build the actual expression node.
12378         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
12379                                                   Best->FoundDecl, Base,
12380                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
12381         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
12382           return ExprError();
12383 
12384         // Determine the result type.
12385         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
12386         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12387         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12388 
12389         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
12390           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(),
12391                                             Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
12392                                             FPFeatures);
12393 
12394         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
12395                                 FnDecl))
12396           return ExprError();
12397 
12398         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
12399         const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr;
12400         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
12401         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
12402           ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0];
12403           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
12404         }
12405 
12406         // Check for a self move.
12407         if (Op == OO_Equal)
12408           DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc);
12409 
12410         checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray,
12411                   isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(),
12412                   VariadicDoesNotApply);
12413 
12414         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12415       } else {
12416         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
12417         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
12418         // operator node.
12419         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
12420             PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0],
12421                                       Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
12422         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
12423           return ExprError();
12424         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
12425 
12426         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
12427             PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1],
12428                                       Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
12429         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
12430           return ExprError();
12431         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
12432         break;
12433       }
12434     }
12435 
12436     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
12437       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
12438       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
12439       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
12440       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
12441       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
12442         break;
12443 
12444       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment
12445       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
12446       // no overloaded assignment operator found
12447       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
12448       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
12449           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
12450         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
12451              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
12452              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12453         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
12454           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
12455             << Args[0]->getType()
12456             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12457         }
12458       } else {
12459         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
12460         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
12461         // defined too late to be candidates.
12462         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
12463           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
12464           return ExprError();
12465 
12466         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
12467         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
12468         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
12469       }
12470       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
12471              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
12472       if (Result.isInvalid())
12473         CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
12474                                     BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
12475       return Result;
12476     }
12477 
12478     case OR_Ambiguous:
12479       Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
12480           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
12481           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
12482           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12483       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
12484                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
12485       return ExprError();
12486 
12487     case OR_Deleted:
12488       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
12489         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
12490         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
12491           << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
12492           << getSpecialMember(Method);
12493 
12494         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
12495         // explain why it's deleted.
12496         NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
12497         return ExprError();
12498       } else {
12499         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
12500           << Best->Function->isDeleted()
12501           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
12502           << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
12503           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12504       }
12505       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
12506                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
12507       return ExprError();
12508   }
12509 
12510   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
12511   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
12512 }
12513 
12514 ExprResult
12515 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
12516                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
12517                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
12518   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
12519   DeclarationName OpName =
12520       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
12521 
12522   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
12523   // expression.
12524   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
12525 
12526     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
12527     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
12528     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
12529     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
12530     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
12531       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
12532                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
12533                                      /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
12534                                      UnresolvedSetIterator(),
12535                                      UnresolvedSetIterator());
12536     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
12537 
12538     return new (Context)
12539         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args,
12540                             Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, FPOptions());
12541   }
12542 
12543   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
12544   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
12545     return ExprError();
12546   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
12547     return ExprError();
12548 
12549   // Build an empty overload set.
12550   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
12551 
12552   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
12553 
12554   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
12555   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
12556 
12557   // Add builtin operator candidates.
12558   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
12559 
12560   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12561 
12562   // Perform overload resolution.
12563   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12564   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
12565     case OR_Success: {
12566       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
12567       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
12568 
12569       if (FnDecl) {
12570         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
12571         // operator.
12572 
12573         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
12574 
12575         // Convert the arguments.
12576         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
12577         ExprResult Arg0 =
12578           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
12579                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12580         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
12581           return ExprError();
12582         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
12583 
12584         // Convert the arguments.
12585         ExprResult InputInit
12586           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
12587                                                       Context,
12588                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
12589                                       SourceLocation(),
12590                                       Args[1]);
12591         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
12592           return ExprError();
12593 
12594         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
12595 
12596         // Build the actual expression node.
12597         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
12598         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
12599         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
12600                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
12601                                                   Base,
12602                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
12603                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
12604                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
12605         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
12606           return ExprError();
12607 
12608         // Determine the result type
12609         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
12610         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12611         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12612 
12613         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
12614           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
12615                                             FnExpr.get(), Args,
12616                                             ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
12617                                             FPOptions());
12618 
12619         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
12620           return ExprError();
12621 
12622         if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
12623                               Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
12624           return ExprError();
12625 
12626         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12627       } else {
12628         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
12629         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
12630         // operator node.
12631         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
12632             PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0],
12633                                       Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
12634         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
12635           return ExprError();
12636         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
12637 
12638         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
12639             PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1],
12640                                       Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
12641         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
12642           return ExprError();
12643         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
12644 
12645         break;
12646       }
12647     }
12648 
12649     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
12650       if (CandidateSet.empty())
12651         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
12652           << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
12653           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12654       else
12655         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
12656           << Args[0]->getType()
12657           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12658       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
12659                                   "[]", LLoc);
12660       return ExprError();
12661     }
12662 
12663     case OR_Ambiguous:
12664       Diag(LLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
12665           << "[]"
12666           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
12667           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12668       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
12669                                   "[]", LLoc);
12670       return ExprError();
12671 
12672     case OR_Deleted:
12673       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
12674         << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
12675         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
12676         << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
12677       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
12678                                   "[]", LLoc);
12679       return ExprError();
12680     }
12681 
12682   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
12683   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
12684 }
12685 
12686 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
12687 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
12688 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
12689 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
12690 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
12691 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
12692 /// member function.
12693 ExprResult
12694 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
12695                                 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12696                                 MultiExprArg Args,
12697                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
12698   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
12699          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12700 
12701   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
12702   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
12703   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
12704 
12705   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
12706   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
12707     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
12708     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
12709 
12710     QualType fnType =
12711       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
12712 
12713     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
12714     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
12715     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
12716 
12717     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
12718     // member function we're calling.
12719     Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
12720 
12721     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
12722     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
12723       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
12724     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
12725 
12726     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
12727     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
12728     difference.removeAddressSpace();
12729     if (difference) {
12730       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
12731       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
12732         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
12733         << qualsString
12734         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
12735     }
12736 
12737     CXXMemberCallExpr *call
12738       = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
12739                                         resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
12740 
12741     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
12742                             call, nullptr))
12743       return ExprError();
12744 
12745     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
12746       return ExprError();
12747 
12748     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
12749       return ExprError();
12750 
12751     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
12752   }
12753 
12754   if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr))
12755     return new (Context)
12756         CallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
12757 
12758   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12759   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
12760     return ExprError();
12761 
12762   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
12763   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
12764   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
12765   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
12766   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
12767     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
12768     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
12769     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
12770     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
12771     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
12772   } else {
12773     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
12774     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
12775 
12776     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
12777     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
12778       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
12779                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
12780 
12781     // Add overload candidates
12782     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12783                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
12784 
12785     // FIXME: avoid copy.
12786     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
12787     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12788       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12789       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12790     }
12791 
12792     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
12793            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12794 
12795       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
12796       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
12797       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
12798         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
12799 
12800 
12801       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
12802       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
12803         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
12804                              Args, CandidateSet);
12805       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
12806         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
12807         // non-template member function.
12808         if (TemplateArgs)
12809           continue;
12810 
12811         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
12812                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
12813                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
12814       } else {
12815         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
12816             cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC,
12817             TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
12818             /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
12819       }
12820     }
12821 
12822     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
12823 
12824     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
12825 
12826     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12827     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
12828                                             Best)) {
12829     case OR_Success:
12830       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
12831       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
12832       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
12833       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
12834         return ExprError();
12835       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
12836       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
12837       // called on both.
12838       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
12839       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
12840       // being used.
12841       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
12842                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
12843         return ExprError();
12844       break;
12845 
12846     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12847       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12848            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
12849         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
12850       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12851       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
12852       return ExprError();
12853 
12854     case OR_Ambiguous:
12855       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
12856         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
12857       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12858       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
12859       return ExprError();
12860 
12861     case OR_Deleted:
12862       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
12863         << Best->Function->isDeleted()
12864         << DeclName
12865         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
12866         << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
12867       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12868       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
12869       return ExprError();
12870     }
12871 
12872     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
12873 
12874     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
12875     // non-member call based on that function.
12876     if (Method->isStatic()) {
12877       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
12878                                    RParenLoc);
12879     }
12880 
12881     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
12882   }
12883 
12884   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
12885   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
12886   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12887 
12888   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
12889   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
12890     new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
12891                                     ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
12892 
12893   // Check for a valid return type.
12894   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12895                           TheCall, Method))
12896     return ExprError();
12897 
12898   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
12899   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
12900   // it was done at lookup.
12901   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
12902     ExprResult ObjectArg =
12903       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
12904                                           FoundDecl, Method);
12905     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
12906       return ExprError();
12907     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
12908   }
12909 
12910   // Convert the rest of the arguments
12911   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
12912     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
12913   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
12914                               RParenLoc))
12915     return ExprError();
12916 
12917   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
12918 
12919   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
12920     return ExprError();
12921 
12922   // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading
12923   // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do
12924   // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors.
12925   if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
12926     if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
12927       Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(),
12928            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
12929           << Method << Method->getSourceRange();
12930       Diag(Method->getLocation(),
12931            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
12932           << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
12933       return ExprError();
12934     }
12935   }
12936 
12937   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
12938        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
12939       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
12940     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
12941 
12942     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) &&
12943         MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
12944       Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
12945            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
12946         << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
12947         << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
12948 
12949       Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
12950       if (getLangOpts().AppleKext)
12951         Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
12952              diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext)
12953              << MD->getParent()->getDeclName()
12954              << MD->getDeclName();
12955     }
12956   }
12957 
12958   if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD =
12959           dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) {
12960     // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode.
12961     bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext;
12962     CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getLocStart(), /*IsDelete=*/false,
12963                          CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true,
12964                          MemExpr->getMemberLoc());
12965   }
12966 
12967   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12968 }
12969 
12970 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
12971 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
12972 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
12973 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
12974 ExprResult
12975 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
12976                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12977                                    MultiExprArg Args,
12978                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
12979   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
12980     return ExprError();
12981   ExprResult Object = Obj;
12982 
12983   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12984   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
12985     return ExprError();
12986 
12987   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() &&
12988          "Requires object type argument");
12989   const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
12990 
12991   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
12992   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
12993   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
12994   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
12995   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
12996   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
12997   //  (E).operator().
12998   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
12999                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13000   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
13001 
13002   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
13003                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
13004     return true;
13005 
13006   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
13007   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
13008   R.suppressDiagnostics();
13009 
13010   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
13011        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
13012     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
13013                        Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet,
13014                        /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
13015   }
13016 
13017   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
13018   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
13019   //   declared in T of the form
13020   //
13021   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
13022   //
13023   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
13024   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
13025   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
13026   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
13027   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
13028   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
13029   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
13030   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
13031   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
13032   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
13033   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
13034   const auto &Conversions =
13035       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
13036   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
13037     NamedDecl *D = *I;
13038     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
13039     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
13040       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
13041 
13042     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
13043     // surrogates.
13044     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
13045       continue;
13046 
13047     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
13048     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
13049       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
13050       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
13051       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
13052       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
13053         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
13054 
13055       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
13056       {
13057         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
13058                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
13059       }
13060     }
13061   }
13062 
13063   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13064 
13065   // Perform overload resolution.
13066   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13067   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
13068                                           Best)) {
13069   case OR_Success:
13070     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
13071     // below.
13072     break;
13073 
13074   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13075     if (CandidateSet.empty())
13076       Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
13077         << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
13078         << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
13079     else
13080       Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
13081            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
13082         << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
13083     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13084     break;
13085 
13086   case OR_Ambiguous:
13087     Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
13088          diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
13089       << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
13090     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
13091     break;
13092 
13093   case OR_Deleted:
13094     Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
13095          diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
13096       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
13097       << Object.get()->getType()
13098       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
13099       << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
13100     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13101     break;
13102   }
13103 
13104   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
13105     return true;
13106 
13107   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
13108 
13109   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
13110     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
13111     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
13112     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
13113       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
13114                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
13115 
13116     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
13117                               Best->FoundDecl);
13118     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
13119       return ExprError();
13120     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
13121              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
13122     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
13123     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
13124     // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
13125 
13126     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
13127     // and then call it.
13128     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
13129                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
13130     if (Call.isInvalid())
13131       return ExprError();
13132     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
13133     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
13134                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
13135                                     nullptr, VK_RValue);
13136 
13137     return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
13138   }
13139 
13140   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
13141 
13142   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
13143   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
13144   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
13145   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
13146 
13147   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
13148   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
13149     return ExprError();
13150 
13151   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
13152     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
13153 
13154   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
13155 
13156   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
13157                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
13158   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
13159   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
13160                                            Obj, HadMultipleCandidates,
13161                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
13162                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
13163   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
13164     return true;
13165 
13166   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
13167   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
13168   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(Args.size() + 1);
13169   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
13170   std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), MethodArgs.begin() + 1);
13171 
13172   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
13173   // owned.
13174   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
13175   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13176   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13177 
13178   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context)
13179       CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy,
13180                           VK, RParenLoc, FPOptions());
13181 
13182   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
13183     return true;
13184 
13185   // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
13186   // slots in the call for them.
13187   if (Args.size() < NumParams)
13188     TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1);
13189 
13190   bool IsError = false;
13191 
13192   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
13193   ExprResult ObjRes =
13194     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13195                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13196   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
13197     IsError = true;
13198   else
13199     Object = ObjRes;
13200   TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get());
13201 
13202   // Check the argument types.
13203   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
13204     Expr *Arg;
13205     if (i < Args.size()) {
13206       Arg = Args[i];
13207 
13208       // Pass the argument.
13209 
13210       ExprResult InputInit
13211         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
13212                                                     Context,
13213                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
13214                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
13215 
13216       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
13217       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
13218     } else {
13219       ExprResult DefArg
13220         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
13221       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
13222         IsError = true;
13223         break;
13224       }
13225 
13226       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
13227     }
13228 
13229     TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
13230   }
13231 
13232   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
13233   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
13234     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
13235     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
13236       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
13237                                                         nullptr);
13238       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
13239       TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get());
13240     }
13241   }
13242 
13243   if (IsError) return true;
13244 
13245   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
13246 
13247   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
13248     return true;
13249 
13250   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
13251 }
13252 
13253 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
13254 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
13255 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
13256 ExprResult
13257 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
13258                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
13259   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
13260          "left-hand side must have class type");
13261 
13262   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
13263     return ExprError();
13264 
13265   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
13266 
13267   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
13268   //
13269   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
13270   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
13271   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
13272   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
13273   DeclarationName OpName =
13274     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
13275   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13276   const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
13277 
13278   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
13279                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
13280     return ExprError();
13281 
13282   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
13283   LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
13284   R.suppressDiagnostics();
13285 
13286   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
13287        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
13288     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
13289                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
13290   }
13291 
13292   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13293 
13294   // Perform overload resolution.
13295   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13296   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13297   case OR_Success:
13298     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
13299     break;
13300 
13301   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13302     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
13303       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
13304       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
13305         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
13306         // diagnostic, as requested.
13307         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
13308         return ExprError();
13309       }
13310       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
13311         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
13312       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
13313         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
13314           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
13315       }
13316     } else
13317       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
13318         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
13319     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
13320     return ExprError();
13321 
13322   case OR_Ambiguous:
13323     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
13324       << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
13325     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
13326     return ExprError();
13327 
13328   case OR_Deleted:
13329     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13330       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
13331       << "->"
13332       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
13333       << Base->getSourceRange();
13334     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
13335     return ExprError();
13336   }
13337 
13338   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
13339 
13340   // Convert the object parameter.
13341   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
13342   ExprResult BaseResult =
13343     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13344                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13345   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
13346     return ExprError();
13347   Base = BaseResult.get();
13348 
13349   // Build the operator call.
13350   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
13351                                             Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
13352   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13353     return ExprError();
13354 
13355   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
13356   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13357   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13358   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
13359     new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(),
13360                                       Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions());
13361 
13362   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
13363     return ExprError();
13364 
13365   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
13366                         Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
13367     return ExprError();
13368 
13369   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
13370 }
13371 
13372 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
13373 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
13374 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
13375                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
13376                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
13377                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
13378                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
13379   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
13380 
13381   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
13382                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
13383   AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, TemplateArgs,
13384                         /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true);
13385 
13386   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13387 
13388   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
13389   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
13390   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13391   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
13392   case OR_Success:
13393   case OR_Deleted:
13394     break;
13395 
13396   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13397     Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
13398       << R.getLookupName();
13399     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13400     return ExprError();
13401 
13402   case OR_Ambiguous:
13403     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
13404     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
13405     return ExprError();
13406   }
13407 
13408   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
13409   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
13410                                         nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates,
13411                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
13412                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
13413   if (Fn.isInvalid())
13414     return true;
13415 
13416   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
13417   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
13418   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
13419   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
13420     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
13421       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
13422       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
13423     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
13424       return true;
13425     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
13426   }
13427 
13428   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
13429   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13430   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13431 
13432   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
13433     new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(),
13434                                      llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
13435                                      ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
13436 
13437   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
13438     return ExprError();
13439 
13440   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
13441     return ExprError();
13442 
13443   return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
13444 }
13445 
13446 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
13447 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
13448 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
13449 /// dependent lookup.
13450 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
13451 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
13452 /// is returned.
13453 Sema::ForRangeStatus
13454 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc,
13455                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
13456                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
13457                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
13458                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
13459                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
13460   Scope *S = nullptr;
13461 
13462   CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
13463   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
13464     ExprResult MemberRef =
13465         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
13466                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
13467                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
13468                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
13469                                  MemberLookup,
13470                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
13471     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
13472       *CallExpr = ExprError();
13473       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
13474     }
13475     *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
13476     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
13477       *CallExpr = ExprError();
13478       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
13479     }
13480   } else {
13481     UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
13482     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
13483       UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
13484                                    NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
13485                                    /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
13486                                    FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
13487 
13488     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
13489                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
13490     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
13491       *CallExpr = ExprError();
13492       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
13493     }
13494     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13495     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
13496         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
13497 
13498     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
13499       *CallExpr = ExprError();
13500       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
13501     }
13502     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
13503                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
13504                                          OverloadResult,
13505                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
13506     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
13507       *CallExpr = ExprError();
13508       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
13509     }
13510   }
13511   return FRS_Success;
13512 }
13513 
13514 
13515 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
13516 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
13517 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
13518 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
13519 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
13520 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
13521                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
13522   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
13523     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
13524                                                    Found, Fn);
13525     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
13526       return PE;
13527 
13528     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
13529   }
13530 
13531   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
13532     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
13533                                                    Found, Fn);
13534     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
13535                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
13536            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
13537     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
13538     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
13539       return ICE;
13540 
13541     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
13542                                     ICE->getCastKind(),
13543                                     SubExpr, nullptr,
13544                                     ICE->getValueKind());
13545   }
13546 
13547   if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) {
13548     if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) {
13549       Expr *SubExpr =
13550           FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn);
13551       if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr())
13552         return GSE;
13553 
13554       // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic
13555       // selection expression.
13556       ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs();
13557       SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end());
13558       unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex();
13559       AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr;
13560 
13561       return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
13562           Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(),
13563           GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
13564           GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(),
13565           ResultIdx);
13566     }
13567     // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic
13568     // selection expression.
13569     return GSE;
13570   }
13571 
13572   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
13573     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
13574            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
13575     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
13576       if (Method->isStatic()) {
13577         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
13578         // from non-member functions.
13579       } else {
13580         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
13581         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
13582         // or template.
13583         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
13584                                                        Found, Fn);
13585         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
13586           return UnOp;
13587 
13588         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
13589                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
13590         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
13591                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
13592 
13593         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
13594         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
13595         // appropriate pointer to member type.
13596         QualType ClassType
13597           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
13598         QualType MemPtrType
13599           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
13600         // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
13601         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
13602           (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType);
13603 
13604         return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
13605                                            VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
13606                                            UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false);
13607       }
13608     }
13609     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
13610                                                    Found, Fn);
13611     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
13612       return UnOp;
13613 
13614     return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
13615                                      Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
13616                                        VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
13617                                        UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false);
13618   }
13619 
13620   // C++ [except.spec]p17:
13621   //   An exception-specification is considered to be needed when:
13622   //   - in an expression the function is the unique lookup result or the
13623   //     selected member of a set of overloaded functions
13624   if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
13625     ResolveExceptionSpec(E->getExprLoc(), FPT);
13626 
13627   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
13628     // FIXME: avoid copy.
13629     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
13630     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
13631       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
13632       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
13633     }
13634 
13635     DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
13636                                            ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
13637                                            ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
13638                                            Fn,
13639                                            /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
13640                                            ULE->getNameLoc(),
13641                                            Fn->getType(),
13642                                            VK_LValue,
13643                                            Found.getDecl(),
13644                                            TemplateArgs);
13645     MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
13646     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
13647     return DRE;
13648   }
13649 
13650   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
13651     // FIXME: avoid copy.
13652     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
13653     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
13654       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
13655       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
13656     }
13657 
13658     Expr *Base;
13659 
13660     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
13661     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
13662     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
13663       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
13664         DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
13665                                                MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
13666                                                MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
13667                                                Fn,
13668                                                /*enclosing*/ false,
13669                                                MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
13670                                                Fn->getType(),
13671                                                VK_LValue,
13672                                                Found.getDecl(),
13673                                                TemplateArgs);
13674         MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
13675         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
13676         return DRE;
13677       } else {
13678         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
13679         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
13680           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
13681         CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
13682         Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
13683                                          MemExpr->getBaseType(),
13684                                          /*isImplicit=*/true);
13685       }
13686     } else
13687       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
13688 
13689     ExprValueKind valueKind;
13690     QualType type;
13691     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
13692       valueKind = VK_LValue;
13693       type = Fn->getType();
13694     } else {
13695       valueKind = VK_RValue;
13696       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
13697     }
13698 
13699     MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(
13700         Context, Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(),
13701         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found,
13702         MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), TemplateArgs, type, valueKind,
13703         OK_Ordinary);
13704     ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
13705     MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
13706     return ME;
13707   }
13708 
13709   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
13710 }
13711 
13712 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
13713                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
13714                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
13715   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
13716 }
13717